834
|
1 *eval.txt* For Vim version 7.0e. Last change: 2006 Apr 15
|
7
|
2
|
|
3
|
|
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
|
5
|
|
6
|
|
7 Expression evaluation *expression* *expr* *E15* *eval*
|
|
8
|
|
9 Using expressions is introduced in chapter 41 of the user manual |usr_41.txt|.
|
|
10
|
|
11 Note: Expression evaluation can be disabled at compile time. If this has been
|
205
|
12 done, the features in this document are not available. See |+eval| and
|
99
|
13 |no-eval-feature|.
|
7
|
14
|
85
|
15 1. Variables |variables|
|
|
16 1.1 Variable types
|
87
|
17 1.2 Function references |Funcref|
|
161
|
18 1.3 Lists |Lists|
|
99
|
19 1.4 Dictionaries |Dictionaries|
|
|
20 1.5 More about variables |more-variables|
|
85
|
21 2. Expression syntax |expression-syntax|
|
|
22 3. Internal variable |internal-variables|
|
|
23 4. Builtin Functions |functions|
|
|
24 5. Defining functions |user-functions|
|
|
25 6. Curly braces names |curly-braces-names|
|
|
26 7. Commands |expression-commands|
|
|
27 8. Exception handling |exception-handling|
|
|
28 9. Examples |eval-examples|
|
|
29 10. No +eval feature |no-eval-feature|
|
|
30 11. The sandbox |eval-sandbox|
|
634
|
31 12. Textlock |textlock|
|
7
|
32
|
|
33 {Vi does not have any of these commands}
|
|
34
|
|
35 ==============================================================================
|
|
36 1. Variables *variables*
|
|
37
|
85
|
38 1.1 Variable types ~
|
114
|
39 *E712*
|
370
|
40 There are five types of variables:
|
55
|
41
|
99
|
42 Number A 32 bit signed number.
|
|
43 Examples: -123 0x10 0177
|
|
44
|
|
45 String A NUL terminated string of 8-bit unsigned characters (bytes).
|
|
46 Examples: "ab\txx\"--" 'x-z''a,c'
|
|
47
|
|
48 Funcref A reference to a function |Funcref|.
|
|
49 Example: function("strlen")
|
|
50
|
|
51 List An ordered sequence of items |List|.
|
|
52 Example: [1, 2, ['a', 'b']]
|
55
|
53
|
370
|
54 Dictionary An associative, unordered array: Each entry has a key and a
|
|
55 value. |Dictionary|
|
|
56 Example: {'blue': "#0000ff", 'red': "#ff0000"}
|
|
57
|
55
|
58 The Number and String types are converted automatically, depending on how they
|
|
59 are used.
|
7
|
60
|
|
61 Conversion from a Number to a String is by making the ASCII representation of
|
|
62 the Number. Examples: >
|
|
63 Number 123 --> String "123"
|
|
64 Number 0 --> String "0"
|
|
65 Number -1 --> String "-1"
|
|
66
|
|
67 Conversion from a String to a Number is done by converting the first digits
|
|
68 to a number. Hexadecimal "0xf9" and Octal "017" numbers are recognized. If
|
|
69 the String doesn't start with digits, the result is zero. Examples: >
|
|
70 String "456" --> Number 456
|
|
71 String "6bar" --> Number 6
|
|
72 String "foo" --> Number 0
|
|
73 String "0xf1" --> Number 241
|
|
74 String "0100" --> Number 64
|
|
75 String "-8" --> Number -8
|
|
76 String "+8" --> Number 0
|
|
77
|
|
78 To force conversion from String to Number, add zero to it: >
|
|
79 :echo "0100" + 0
|
782
|
80 < 64 ~
|
|
81
|
|
82 To avoid a leading zero to cause octal conversion, or for using a different
|
|
83 base, use |str2nr()|.
|
7
|
84
|
|
85 For boolean operators Numbers are used. Zero is FALSE, non-zero is TRUE.
|
|
86
|
|
87 Note that in the command >
|
|
88 :if "foo"
|
|
89 "foo" is converted to 0, which means FALSE. To test for a non-empty string,
|
|
90 use strlen(): >
|
|
91 :if strlen("foo")
|
153
|
92 < *E745* *E728* *E703* *E729* *E730* *E731*
|
|
93 List, Dictionary and Funcref types are not automatically converted.
|
85
|
94
|
|
95 *E706*
|
|
96 You will get an error if you try to change the type of a variable. You need
|
|
97 to |:unlet| it first to avoid this error. String and Number are considered
|
99
|
98 equivalent though. Consider this sequence of commands: >
|
85
|
99 :let l = "string"
|
87
|
100 :let l = 44 " changes type from String to Number
|
85
|
101 :let l = [1, 2, 3] " error!
|
|
102
|
|
103
|
87
|
104 1.2 Function references ~
|
153
|
105 *Funcref* *E695* *E718*
|
55
|
106 A Funcref variable is obtained with the |function()| function. It can be used
|
114
|
107 in an expression in the place of a function name, before the parenthesis
|
|
108 around the arguments, to invoke the function it refers to. Example: >
|
55
|
109
|
|
110 :let Fn = function("MyFunc")
|
|
111 :echo Fn()
|
114
|
112 < *E704* *E705* *E707*
|
819
|
113 A Funcref variable must start with a capital, "s:", "w:", "t:" or "b:". You
|
|
114 cannot have both a Funcref variable and a function with the same name.
|
85
|
115
|
114
|
116 A special case is defining a function and directly assigning its Funcref to a
|
|
117 Dictionary entry. Example: >
|
|
118 :function dict.init() dict
|
|
119 : let self.val = 0
|
|
120 :endfunction
|
|
121
|
|
122 The key of the Dictionary can start with a lower case letter. The actual
|
|
123 function name is not used here. Also see |numbered-function|.
|
|
124
|
|
125 A Funcref can also be used with the |:call| command: >
|
|
126 :call Fn()
|
|
127 :call dict.init()
|
85
|
128
|
|
129 The name of the referenced function can be obtained with |string()|. >
|
119
|
130 :let func = string(Fn)
|
85
|
131
|
|
132 You can use |call()| to invoke a Funcref and use a list variable for the
|
|
133 arguments: >
|
119
|
134 :let r = call(Fn, mylist)
|
85
|
135
|
|
136
|
87
|
137 1.3 Lists ~
|
161
|
138 *List* *Lists* *E686*
|
55
|
139 A List is an ordered sequence of items. An item can be of any type. Items
|
|
140 can be accessed by their index number. Items can be added and removed at any
|
|
141 position in the sequence.
|
|
142
|
85
|
143
|
|
144 List creation ~
|
|
145 *E696* *E697*
|
55
|
146 A List is created with a comma separated list of items in square brackets.
|
85
|
147 Examples: >
|
|
148 :let mylist = [1, two, 3, "four"]
|
|
149 :let emptylist = []
|
55
|
150
|
|
151 An item can be any expression. Using a List for an item creates a
|
85
|
152 nested List: >
|
|
153 :let nestlist = [[11, 12], [21, 22], [31, 32]]
|
55
|
154
|
|
155 An extra comma after the last item is ignored.
|
|
156
|
85
|
157
|
|
158 List index ~
|
|
159 *list-index* *E684*
|
55
|
160 An item in the List can be accessed by putting the index in square brackets
|
85
|
161 after the List. Indexes are zero-based, thus the first item has index zero. >
|
|
162 :let item = mylist[0] " get the first item: 1
|
55
|
163 :let item = mylist[2] " get the third item: 3
|
85
|
164
|
87
|
165 When the resulting item is a list this can be repeated: >
|
85
|
166 :let item = nestlist[0][1] " get the first list, second item: 12
|
55
|
167 <
|
85
|
168 A negative index is counted from the end. Index -1 refers to the last item in
|
|
169 the List, -2 to the last but one item, etc. >
|
55
|
170 :let last = mylist[-1] " get the last item: "four"
|
|
171
|
85
|
172 To avoid an error for an invalid index use the |get()| function. When an item
|
87
|
173 is not available it returns zero or the default value you specify: >
|
85
|
174 :echo get(mylist, idx)
|
|
175 :echo get(mylist, idx, "NONE")
|
|
176
|
|
177
|
|
178 List concatenation ~
|
|
179
|
|
180 Two lists can be concatenated with the "+" operator: >
|
|
181 :let longlist = mylist + [5, 6]
|
119
|
182 :let mylist += [7, 8]
|
85
|
183
|
|
184 To prepend or append an item turn the item into a list by putting [] around
|
|
185 it. To change a list in-place see |list-modification| below.
|
|
186
|
|
187
|
|
188 Sublist ~
|
|
189
|
55
|
190 A part of the List can be obtained by specifying the first and last index,
|
|
191 separated by a colon in square brackets: >
|
85
|
192 :let shortlist = mylist[2:-1] " get List [3, "four"]
|
55
|
193
|
|
194 Omitting the first index is similar to zero. Omitting the last index is
|
|
195 similar to -1. The difference is that there is no error if the items are not
|
|
196 available. >
|
90
|
197 :let endlist = mylist[2:] " from item 2 to the end: [3, "four"]
|
|
198 :let shortlist = mylist[2:2] " List with one item: [3]
|
|
199 :let otherlist = mylist[:] " make a copy of the List
|
85
|
200
|
829
|
201 If the second index is equal to or greater than the length of the list there
|
|
202 is no error and the length minus one is used: >
|
|
203 :let mylist = [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
|
204 :echo mylist[2:8] " result: [2, 3]
|
|
205
|
99
|
206 The second index can be just before the first index. In that case the result
|
|
207 is an empty list. If the second index is lower, this results in an error. >
|
|
208 :echo mylist[2:1] " result: []
|
|
209 :echo mylist[2:0] " error!
|
|
210
|
270
|
211 NOTE: mylist[s:e] means using the variable "s:e" as index. Watch out for
|
|
212 using a single letter variable before the ":". Insert a space when needed:
|
|
213 mylist[s : e].
|
|
214
|
85
|
215
|
|
216 List identity ~
|
99
|
217 *list-identity*
|
85
|
218 When variable "aa" is a list and you assign it to another variable "bb", both
|
|
219 variables refer to the same list. Thus changing the list "aa" will also
|
|
220 change "bb": >
|
|
221 :let aa = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
222 :let bb = aa
|
|
223 :call add(aa, 4)
|
|
224 :echo bb
|
114
|
225 < [1, 2, 3, 4]
|
85
|
226
|
|
227 Making a copy of a list is done with the |copy()| function. Using [:] also
|
|
228 works, as explained above. This creates a shallow copy of the list: Changing
|
87
|
229 a list item in the list will also change the item in the copied list: >
|
85
|
230 :let aa = [[1, 'a'], 2, 3]
|
|
231 :let bb = copy(aa)
|
114
|
232 :call add(aa, 4)
|
85
|
233 :let aa[0][1] = 'aaa'
|
|
234 :echo aa
|
114
|
235 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3, 4] >
|
85
|
236 :echo bb
|
114
|
237 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3]
|
85
|
238
|
87
|
239 To make a completely independent list use |deepcopy()|. This also makes a
|
114
|
240 copy of the values in the list, recursively. Up to a hundred levels deep.
|
85
|
241
|
|
242 The operator "is" can be used to check if two variables refer to the same
|
114
|
243 List. "isnot" does the opposite. In contrast "==" compares if two lists have
|
87
|
244 the same value. >
|
|
245 :let alist = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
246 :let blist = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
247 :echo alist is blist
|
114
|
248 < 0 >
|
87
|
249 :echo alist == blist
|
114
|
250 < 1
|
85
|
251
|
323
|
252 Note about comparing lists: Two lists are considered equal if they have the
|
|
253 same length and all items compare equal, as with using "==". There is one
|
388
|
254 exception: When comparing a number with a string they are considered
|
|
255 different. There is no automatic type conversion, as with using "==" on
|
|
256 variables. Example: >
|
|
257 echo 4 == "4"
|
323
|
258 < 1 >
|
388
|
259 echo [4] == ["4"]
|
323
|
260 < 0
|
|
261
|
388
|
262 Thus comparing Lists is more strict than comparing numbers and strings. You
|
|
263 can compare simple values this way too by putting them in a string: >
|
|
264
|
|
265 :let a = 5
|
|
266 :let b = "5"
|
|
267 echo a == b
|
|
268 < 1 >
|
|
269 echo [a] == [b]
|
|
270 < 0
|
323
|
271
|
85
|
272
|
|
273 List unpack ~
|
|
274
|
|
275 To unpack the items in a list to individual variables, put the variables in
|
|
276 square brackets, like list items: >
|
|
277 :let [var1, var2] = mylist
|
|
278
|
|
279 When the number of variables does not match the number of items in the list
|
|
280 this produces an error. To handle any extra items from the list append ";"
|
|
281 and a variable name: >
|
|
282 :let [var1, var2; rest] = mylist
|
|
283
|
|
284 This works like: >
|
|
285 :let var1 = mylist[0]
|
|
286 :let var2 = mylist[1]
|
95
|
287 :let rest = mylist[2:]
|
85
|
288
|
|
289 Except that there is no error if there are only two items. "rest" will be an
|
|
290 empty list then.
|
|
291
|
|
292
|
|
293 List modification ~
|
|
294 *list-modification*
|
87
|
295 To change a specific item of a list use |:let| this way: >
|
85
|
296 :let list[4] = "four"
|
|
297 :let listlist[0][3] = item
|
|
298
|
87
|
299 To change part of a list you can specify the first and last item to be
|
114
|
300 modified. The value must at least have the number of items in the range: >
|
87
|
301 :let list[3:5] = [3, 4, 5]
|
|
302
|
85
|
303 Adding and removing items from a list is done with functions. Here are a few
|
|
304 examples: >
|
|
305 :call insert(list, 'a') " prepend item 'a'
|
|
306 :call insert(list, 'a', 3) " insert item 'a' before list[3]
|
|
307 :call add(list, "new") " append String item
|
114
|
308 :call add(list, [1, 2]) " append a List as one new item
|
85
|
309 :call extend(list, [1, 2]) " extend the list with two more items
|
|
310 :let i = remove(list, 3) " remove item 3
|
108
|
311 :unlet list[3] " idem
|
85
|
312 :let l = remove(list, 3, -1) " remove items 3 to last item
|
108
|
313 :unlet list[3 : ] " idem
|
114
|
314 :call filter(list, 'v:val !~ "x"') " remove items with an 'x'
|
|
315
|
|
316 Changing the order of items in a list: >
|
87
|
317 :call sort(list) " sort a list alphabetically
|
|
318 :call reverse(list) " reverse the order of items
|
|
319
|
85
|
320
|
|
321 For loop ~
|
|
322
|
87
|
323 The |:for| loop executes commands for each item in a list. A variable is set
|
|
324 to each item in the list in sequence. Example: >
|
114
|
325 :for item in mylist
|
|
326 : call Doit(item)
|
85
|
327 :endfor
|
|
328
|
|
329 This works like: >
|
|
330 :let index = 0
|
|
331 :while index < len(mylist)
|
114
|
332 : let item = mylist[index]
|
|
333 : :call Doit(item)
|
85
|
334 : let index = index + 1
|
|
335 :endwhile
|
|
336
|
|
337 Note that all items in the list should be of the same type, otherwise this
|
114
|
338 results in error |E706|. To avoid this |:unlet| the variable at the end of
|
87
|
339 the loop.
|
85
|
340
|
95
|
341 If all you want to do is modify each item in the list then the |map()|
|
114
|
342 function will be a simpler method than a for loop.
|
95
|
343
|
85
|
344 Just like the |:let| command, |:for| also accepts a list of variables. This
|
|
345 requires the argument to be a list of lists. >
|
|
346 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 8], [3, 0]]
|
|
347 : call Doit(lnum, col)
|
|
348 :endfor
|
|
349
|
|
350 This works like a |:let| command is done for each list item. Again, the types
|
|
351 must remain the same to avoid an error.
|
|
352
|
114
|
353 It is also possible to put remaining items in a List variable: >
|
85
|
354 :for [i, j; rest] in listlist
|
|
355 : call Doit(i, j)
|
|
356 : if !empty(rest)
|
|
357 : echo "remainder: " . string(rest)
|
|
358 : endif
|
|
359 :endfor
|
|
360
|
|
361
|
|
362 List functions ~
|
114
|
363 *E714*
|
85
|
364 Functions that are useful with a List: >
|
87
|
365 :let r = call(funcname, list) " call a function with an argument list
|
85
|
366 :if empty(list) " check if list is empty
|
102
|
367 :let l = len(list) " number of items in list
|
|
368 :let big = max(list) " maximum value in list
|
|
369 :let small = min(list) " minimum value in list
|
87
|
370 :let xs = count(list, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in list
|
|
371 :let i = index(list, 'x') " index of first 'x' in list
|
85
|
372 :let lines = getline(1, 10) " get ten text lines from buffer
|
|
373 :call append('$', lines) " append text lines in buffer
|
95
|
374 :let list = split("a b c") " create list from items in a string
|
|
375 :let string = join(list, ', ') " create string from list items
|
102
|
376 :let s = string(list) " String representation of list
|
|
377 :call map(list, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
|
99
|
378
|
258
|
379 Don't forget that a combination of features can make things simple. For
|
|
380 example, to add up all the numbers in a list: >
|
|
381 :exe 'let sum = ' . join(nrlist, '+')
|
|
382
|
99
|
383
|
|
384 1.4 Dictionaries ~
|
114
|
385 *Dictionaries* *Dictionary*
|
99
|
386 A Dictionary is an associative array: Each entry has a key and a value. The
|
114
|
387 entry can be located with the key. The entries are stored without a specific
|
|
388 ordering.
|
99
|
389
|
|
390
|
|
391 Dictionary creation ~
|
114
|
392 *E720* *E721* *E722* *E723*
|
99
|
393 A Dictionary is created with a comma separated list of entries in curly
|
114
|
394 braces. Each entry has a key and a value, separated by a colon. Each key can
|
|
395 only appear once. Examples: >
|
99
|
396 :let mydict = {1: 'one', 2: 'two', 3: 'three'}
|
|
397 :let emptydict = {}
|
114
|
398 < *E713* *E716* *E717*
|
99
|
399 A key is always a String. You can use a Number, it will be converted to a
|
|
400 String automatically. Thus the String '4' and the number 4 will find the same
|
114
|
401 entry. Note that the String '04' and the Number 04 are different, since the
|
|
402 Number will be converted to the String '4'.
|
|
403
|
|
404 A value can be any expression. Using a Dictionary for a value creates a
|
99
|
405 nested Dictionary: >
|
|
406 :let nestdict = {1: {11: 'a', 12: 'b'}, 2: {21: 'c'}}
|
|
407
|
|
408 An extra comma after the last entry is ignored.
|
|
409
|
|
410
|
|
411 Accessing entries ~
|
|
412
|
|
413 The normal way to access an entry is by putting the key in square brackets: >
|
|
414 :let val = mydict["one"]
|
|
415 :let mydict["four"] = 4
|
|
416
|
114
|
417 You can add new entries to an existing Dictionary this way, unlike Lists.
|
99
|
418
|
|
419 For keys that consist entirely of letters, digits and underscore the following
|
|
420 form can be used |expr-entry|: >
|
|
421 :let val = mydict.one
|
|
422 :let mydict.four = 4
|
|
423
|
|
424 Since an entry can be any type, also a List and a Dictionary, the indexing and
|
|
425 key lookup can be repeated: >
|
114
|
426 :echo dict.key[idx].key
|
99
|
427
|
|
428
|
|
429 Dictionary to List conversion ~
|
|
430
|
|
431 You may want to loop over the entries in a dictionary. For this you need to
|
|
432 turn the Dictionary into a List and pass it to |:for|.
|
|
433
|
|
434 Most often you want to loop over the keys, using the |keys()| function: >
|
|
435 :for key in keys(mydict)
|
|
436 : echo key . ': ' . mydict[key]
|
|
437 :endfor
|
|
438
|
|
439 The List of keys is unsorted. You may want to sort them first: >
|
|
440 :for key in sort(keys(mydict))
|
|
441
|
|
442 To loop over the values use the |values()| function: >
|
|
443 :for v in values(mydict)
|
|
444 : echo "value: " . v
|
|
445 :endfor
|
|
446
|
|
447 If you want both the key and the value use the |items()| function. It returns
|
114
|
448 a List in which each item is a List with two items, the key and the value: >
|
99
|
449 :for entry in items(mydict)
|
|
450 : echo entry[0] . ': ' . entry[1]
|
|
451 :endfor
|
|
452
|
|
453
|
|
454 Dictionary identity ~
|
161
|
455 *dict-identity*
|
99
|
456 Just like Lists you need to use |copy()| and |deepcopy()| to make a copy of a
|
|
457 Dictionary. Otherwise, assignment results in referring to the same
|
|
458 Dictionary: >
|
|
459 :let onedict = {'a': 1, 'b': 2}
|
|
460 :let adict = onedict
|
|
461 :let adict['a'] = 11
|
|
462 :echo onedict['a']
|
|
463 11
|
|
464
|
327
|
465 Two Dictionaries compare equal if all the key-value pairs compare equal. For
|
|
466 more info see |list-identity|.
|
99
|
467
|
|
468
|
|
469 Dictionary modification ~
|
|
470 *dict-modification*
|
|
471 To change an already existing entry of a Dictionary, or to add a new entry,
|
|
472 use |:let| this way: >
|
|
473 :let dict[4] = "four"
|
|
474 :let dict['one'] = item
|
|
475
|
108
|
476 Removing an entry from a Dictionary is done with |remove()| or |:unlet|.
|
|
477 Three ways to remove the entry with key "aaa" from dict: >
|
|
478 :let i = remove(dict, 'aaa')
|
|
479 :unlet dict.aaa
|
|
480 :unlet dict['aaa']
|
99
|
481
|
|
482 Merging a Dictionary with another is done with |extend()|: >
|
114
|
483 :call extend(adict, bdict)
|
|
484 This extends adict with all entries from bdict. Duplicate keys cause entries
|
|
485 in adict to be overwritten. An optional third argument can change this.
|
119
|
486 Note that the order of entries in a Dictionary is irrelevant, thus don't
|
|
487 expect ":echo adict" to show the items from bdict after the older entries in
|
|
488 adict.
|
99
|
489
|
|
490 Weeding out entries from a Dictionary can be done with |filter()|: >
|
205
|
491 :call filter(dict 'v:val =~ "x"')
|
114
|
492 This removes all entries from "dict" with a value not matching 'x'.
|
102
|
493
|
|
494
|
|
495 Dictionary function ~
|
114
|
496 *Dictionary-function* *self* *E725*
|
102
|
497 When a function is defined with the "dict" attribute it can be used in a
|
|
498 special way with a dictionary. Example: >
|
|
499 :function Mylen() dict
|
114
|
500 : return len(self.data)
|
102
|
501 :endfunction
|
114
|
502 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3], 'len': function("Mylen")}
|
|
503 :echo mydict.len()
|
102
|
504
|
|
505 This is like a method in object oriented programming. The entry in the
|
|
506 Dictionary is a |Funcref|. The local variable "self" refers to the dictionary
|
|
507 the function was invoked from.
|
|
508
|
114
|
509 It is also possible to add a function without the "dict" attribute as a
|
|
510 Funcref to a Dictionary, but the "self" variable is not available then.
|
|
511
|
819
|
512 *numbered-function* *anonymous-function*
|
102
|
513 To avoid the extra name for the function it can be defined and directly
|
|
514 assigned to a Dictionary in this way: >
|
114
|
515 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3]}
|
|
516 :function mydict.len() dict
|
|
517 : return len(self.data)
|
102
|
518 :endfunction
|
114
|
519 :echo mydict.len()
|
|
520
|
|
521 The function will then get a number and the value of dict.len is a |Funcref|
|
|
522 that references this function. The function can only be used through a
|
|
523 |Funcref|. It will automatically be deleted when there is no |Funcref|
|
|
524 remaining that refers to it.
|
|
525
|
|
526 It is not necessary to use the "dict" attribute for a numbered function.
|
102
|
527
|
|
528
|
|
529 Functions for Dictionaries ~
|
114
|
530 *E715*
|
|
531 Functions that can be used with a Dictionary: >
|
102
|
532 :if has_key(dict, 'foo') " TRUE if dict has entry with key "foo"
|
|
533 :if empty(dict) " TRUE if dict is empty
|
|
534 :let l = len(dict) " number of items in dict
|
|
535 :let big = max(dict) " maximum value in dict
|
|
536 :let small = min(dict) " minimum value in dict
|
|
537 :let xs = count(dict, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in dict
|
|
538 :let s = string(dict) " String representation of dict
|
|
539 :call map(dict, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
|
99
|
540
|
|
541
|
|
542 1.5 More about variables ~
|
85
|
543 *more-variables*
|
7
|
544 If you need to know the type of a variable or expression, use the |type()|
|
|
545 function.
|
|
546
|
|
547 When the '!' flag is included in the 'viminfo' option, global variables that
|
|
548 start with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase letter, are
|
|
549 stored in the viminfo file |viminfo-file|.
|
|
550
|
|
551 When the 'sessionoptions' option contains "global", global variables that
|
|
552 start with an uppercase letter and contain at least one lowercase letter are
|
|
553 stored in the session file |session-file|.
|
|
554
|
|
555 variable name can be stored where ~
|
|
556 my_var_6 not
|
|
557 My_Var_6 session file
|
|
558 MY_VAR_6 viminfo file
|
|
559
|
|
560
|
|
561 It's possible to form a variable name with curly braces, see
|
|
562 |curly-braces-names|.
|
|
563
|
|
564 ==============================================================================
|
|
565 2. Expression syntax *expression-syntax*
|
|
566
|
|
567 Expression syntax summary, from least to most significant:
|
|
568
|
|
569 |expr1| expr2 ? expr1 : expr1 if-then-else
|
|
570
|
|
571 |expr2| expr3 || expr3 .. logical OR
|
|
572
|
|
573 |expr3| expr4 && expr4 .. logical AND
|
|
574
|
|
575 |expr4| expr5 == expr5 equal
|
|
576 expr5 != expr5 not equal
|
|
577 expr5 > expr5 greater than
|
|
578 expr5 >= expr5 greater than or equal
|
|
579 expr5 < expr5 smaller than
|
|
580 expr5 <= expr5 smaller than or equal
|
|
581 expr5 =~ expr5 regexp matches
|
|
582 expr5 !~ expr5 regexp doesn't match
|
|
583
|
|
584 expr5 ==? expr5 equal, ignoring case
|
|
585 expr5 ==# expr5 equal, match case
|
|
586 etc. As above, append ? for ignoring case, # for
|
|
587 matching case
|
|
588
|
685
|
589 expr5 is expr5 same |List| instance
|
|
590 expr5 isnot expr5 different |List| instance
|
79
|
591
|
|
592 |expr5| expr6 + expr6 .. number addition or list concatenation
|
7
|
593 expr6 - expr6 .. number subtraction
|
|
594 expr6 . expr6 .. string concatenation
|
|
595
|
|
596 |expr6| expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication
|
|
597 expr7 / expr7 .. number division
|
|
598 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo
|
|
599
|
|
600 |expr7| ! expr7 logical NOT
|
|
601 - expr7 unary minus
|
|
602 + expr7 unary plus
|
102
|
603
|
|
604
|
685
|
605 |expr8| expr8[expr1] byte of a String or item of a |List|
|
|
606 expr8[expr1 : expr1] substring of a String or sublist of a |List|
|
|
607 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary|
|
|
608 expr8(expr1, ...) function call with |Funcref| variable
|
102
|
609
|
|
610 |expr9| number number constant
|
26
|
611 "string" string constant, backslash is special
|
99
|
612 'string' string constant, ' is doubled
|
685
|
613 [expr1, ...] |List|
|
|
614 {expr1: expr1, ...} |Dictionary|
|
7
|
615 &option option value
|
|
616 (expr1) nested expression
|
|
617 variable internal variable
|
|
618 va{ria}ble internal variable with curly braces
|
|
619 $VAR environment variable
|
|
620 @r contents of register 'r'
|
|
621 function(expr1, ...) function call
|
|
622 func{ti}on(expr1, ...) function call with curly braces
|
|
623
|
|
624
|
|
625 ".." indicates that the operations in this level can be concatenated.
|
|
626 Example: >
|
|
627 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
|
|
628
|
|
629 All expressions within one level are parsed from left to right.
|
|
630
|
|
631
|
|
632 expr1 *expr1* *E109*
|
|
633 -----
|
|
634
|
|
635 expr2 ? expr1 : expr1
|
|
636
|
|
637 The expression before the '?' is evaluated to a number. If it evaluates to
|
|
638 non-zero, the result is the value of the expression between the '?' and ':',
|
|
639 otherwise the result is the value of the expression after the ':'.
|
|
640 Example: >
|
|
641 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum
|
|
642
|
|
643 Since the first expression is an "expr2", it cannot contain another ?:. The
|
|
644 other two expressions can, thus allow for recursive use of ?:.
|
|
645 Example: >
|
|
646 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum == 1000 ? "last" : lnum
|
|
647
|
|
648 To keep this readable, using |line-continuation| is suggested: >
|
|
649 :echo lnum == 1
|
|
650 :\ ? "top"
|
|
651 :\ : lnum == 1000
|
|
652 :\ ? "last"
|
|
653 :\ : lnum
|
|
654
|
|
655
|
|
656 expr2 and expr3 *expr2* *expr3*
|
|
657 ---------------
|
|
658
|
|
659 *expr-barbar* *expr-&&*
|
|
660 The "||" and "&&" operators take one argument on each side. The arguments
|
|
661 are (converted to) Numbers. The result is:
|
|
662
|
|
663 input output ~
|
|
664 n1 n2 n1 || n2 n1 && n2 ~
|
|
665 zero zero zero zero
|
|
666 zero non-zero non-zero zero
|
|
667 non-zero zero non-zero zero
|
|
668 non-zero non-zero non-zero non-zero
|
|
669
|
|
670 The operators can be concatenated, for example: >
|
|
671
|
|
672 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
|
|
673
|
|
674 Note that "&&" takes precedence over "||", so this has the meaning of: >
|
|
675
|
|
676 &nu || (&list && &shell == "csh")
|
|
677
|
|
678 Once the result is known, the expression "short-circuits", that is, further
|
|
679 arguments are not evaluated. This is like what happens in C. For example: >
|
|
680
|
|
681 let a = 1
|
|
682 echo a || b
|
|
683
|
|
684 This is valid even if there is no variable called "b" because "a" is non-zero,
|
|
685 so the result must be non-zero. Similarly below: >
|
|
686
|
|
687 echo exists("b") && b == "yes"
|
|
688
|
|
689 This is valid whether "b" has been defined or not. The second clause will
|
|
690 only be evaluated if "b" has been defined.
|
|
691
|
|
692
|
|
693 expr4 *expr4*
|
|
694 -----
|
|
695
|
|
696 expr5 {cmp} expr5
|
|
697
|
|
698 Compare two expr5 expressions, resulting in a 0 if it evaluates to false, or 1
|
|
699 if it evaluates to true.
|
|
700
|
|
701 *expr-==* *expr-!=* *expr->* *expr->=*
|
|
702 *expr-<* *expr-<=* *expr-=~* *expr-!~*
|
|
703 *expr-==#* *expr-!=#* *expr->#* *expr->=#*
|
|
704 *expr-<#* *expr-<=#* *expr-=~#* *expr-!~#*
|
|
705 *expr-==?* *expr-!=?* *expr->?* *expr->=?*
|
|
706 *expr-<?* *expr-<=?* *expr-=~?* *expr-!~?*
|
79
|
707 *expr-is*
|
7
|
708 use 'ignorecase' match case ignore case ~
|
|
709 equal == ==# ==?
|
|
710 not equal != !=# !=?
|
|
711 greater than > ># >?
|
|
712 greater than or equal >= >=# >=?
|
|
713 smaller than < <# <?
|
|
714 smaller than or equal <= <=# <=?
|
|
715 regexp matches =~ =~# =~?
|
|
716 regexp doesn't match !~ !~# !~?
|
79
|
717 same instance is
|
|
718 different instance isnot
|
7
|
719
|
|
720 Examples:
|
|
721 "abc" ==# "Abc" evaluates to 0
|
|
722 "abc" ==? "Abc" evaluates to 1
|
|
723 "abc" == "Abc" evaluates to 1 if 'ignorecase' is set, 0 otherwise
|
|
724
|
85
|
725 *E691* *E692*
|
685
|
726 A |List| can only be compared with a |List| and only "equal", "not equal" and
|
|
727 "is" can be used. This compares the values of the list, recursively.
|
|
728 Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
|
79
|
729
|
114
|
730 *E735* *E736*
|
685
|
731 A |Dictionary| can only be compared with a |Dictionary| and only "equal", "not
|
|
732 equal" and "is" can be used. This compares the key/values of the |Dictionary|
|
114
|
733 recursively. Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
|
|
734
|
85
|
735 *E693* *E694*
|
685
|
736 A |Funcref| can only be compared with a |Funcref| and only "equal" and "not
|
|
737 equal" can be used. Case is never ignored.
|
|
738
|
|
739 When using "is" or "isnot" with a |List| this checks if the expressions are
|
|
740 referring to the same |List| instance. A copy of a |List| is different from
|
|
741 the original |List|. When using "is" without a |List| it is equivalent to
|
|
742 using "equal", using "isnot" equivalent to using "not equal". Except that a
|
79
|
743 different type means the values are different. "4 == '4'" is true, "4 is '4'"
|
|
744 is false.
|
|
745
|
7
|
746 When comparing a String with a Number, the String is converted to a Number,
|
|
747 and the comparison is done on Numbers. This means that "0 == 'x'" is TRUE,
|
|
748 because 'x' converted to a Number is zero.
|
|
749
|
|
750 When comparing two Strings, this is done with strcmp() or stricmp(). This
|
|
751 results in the mathematical difference (comparing byte values), not
|
|
752 necessarily the alphabetical difference in the local language.
|
|
753
|
|
754 When using the operators with a trailing '#", or the short version and
|
|
755 'ignorecase' is off, the comparing is done with strcmp().
|
|
756
|
|
757 When using the operators with a trailing '?', or the short version and
|
|
758 'ignorecase' is set, the comparing is done with stricmp().
|
|
759
|
|
760 The "=~" and "!~" operators match the lefthand argument with the righthand
|
|
761 argument, which is used as a pattern. See |pattern| for what a pattern is.
|
|
762 This matching is always done like 'magic' was set and 'cpoptions' is empty, no
|
|
763 matter what the actual value of 'magic' or 'cpoptions' is. This makes scripts
|
|
764 portable. To avoid backslashes in the regexp pattern to be doubled, use a
|
|
765 single-quote string, see |literal-string|.
|
|
766 Since a string is considered to be a single line, a multi-line pattern
|
|
767 (containing \n, backslash-n) will not match. However, a literal NL character
|
|
768 can be matched like an ordinary character. Examples:
|
|
769 "foo\nbar" =~ "\n" evaluates to 1
|
|
770 "foo\nbar" =~ "\\n" evaluates to 0
|
|
771
|
|
772
|
|
773 expr5 and expr6 *expr5* *expr6*
|
|
774 ---------------
|
685
|
775 expr6 + expr6 .. Number addition or |List| concatenation *expr-+*
|
79
|
776 expr6 - expr6 .. Number subtraction *expr--*
|
|
777 expr6 . expr6 .. String concatenation *expr-.*
|
|
778
|
692
|
779 For |Lists| only "+" is possible and then both expr6 must be a list. The
|
685
|
780 result is a new list with the two lists Concatenated.
|
79
|
781
|
|
782 expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication *expr-star*
|
|
783 expr7 / expr7 .. number division *expr-/*
|
|
784 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo *expr-%*
|
7
|
785
|
|
786 For all, except ".", Strings are converted to Numbers.
|
|
787
|
|
788 Note the difference between "+" and ".":
|
|
789 "123" + "456" = 579
|
|
790 "123" . "456" = "123456"
|
|
791
|
|
792 When the righthand side of '/' is zero, the result is 0x7fffffff.
|
|
793 When the righthand side of '%' is zero, the result is 0.
|
|
794
|
685
|
795 None of these work for |Funcref|s.
|
79
|
796
|
7
|
797
|
|
798 expr7 *expr7*
|
|
799 -----
|
|
800 ! expr7 logical NOT *expr-!*
|
|
801 - expr7 unary minus *expr-unary--*
|
|
802 + expr7 unary plus *expr-unary-+*
|
|
803
|
|
804 For '!' non-zero becomes zero, zero becomes one.
|
|
805 For '-' the sign of the number is changed.
|
|
806 For '+' the number is unchanged.
|
|
807
|
|
808 A String will be converted to a Number first.
|
|
809
|
|
810 These three can be repeated and mixed. Examples:
|
|
811 !-1 == 0
|
|
812 !!8 == 1
|
|
813 --9 == 9
|
|
814
|
|
815
|
|
816 expr8 *expr8*
|
|
817 -----
|
685
|
818 expr8[expr1] item of String or |List| *expr-[]* *E111*
|
102
|
819
|
|
820 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in a String that contains the
|
|
821 expr1'th single byte from expr8. expr8 is used as a String, expr1 as a
|
55
|
822 Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte encodings.
|
|
823
|
|
824 Index zero gives the first character. This is like it works in C. Careful:
|
|
825 text column numbers start with one! Example, to get the character under the
|
|
826 cursor: >
|
823
|
827 :let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1]
|
7
|
828
|
|
829 If the length of the String is less than the index, the result is an empty
|
55
|
830 String. A negative index always results in an empty string (reason: backwards
|
|
831 compatibility). Use [-1:] to get the last byte.
|
|
832
|
685
|
833 If expr8 is a |List| then it results the item at index expr1. See |list-index|
|
55
|
834 for possible index values. If the index is out of range this results in an
|
|
835 error. Example: >
|
|
836 :let item = mylist[-1] " get last item
|
|
837
|
685
|
838 Generally, if a |List| index is equal to or higher than the length of the
|
|
839 |List|, or more negative than the length of the |List|, this results in an
|
|
840 error.
|
55
|
841
|
99
|
842
|
102
|
843 expr8[expr1a : expr1b] substring or sublist *expr-[:]*
|
|
844
|
|
845 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in the substring with the bytes
|
|
846 from expr1a to and including expr1b. expr8 is used as a String, expr1a and
|
55
|
847 expr1b are used as a Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte
|
|
848 encodings.
|
|
849
|
|
850 If expr1a is omitted zero is used. If expr1b is omitted the length of the
|
|
851 string minus one is used.
|
|
852
|
|
853 A negative number can be used to measure from the end of the string. -1 is
|
|
854 the last character, -2 the last but one, etc.
|
|
855
|
|
856 If an index goes out of range for the string characters are omitted. If
|
|
857 expr1b is smaller than expr1a the result is an empty string.
|
|
858
|
|
859 Examples: >
|
|
860 :let c = name[-1:] " last byte of a string
|
|
861 :let c = name[-2:-2] " last but one byte of a string
|
|
862 :let s = line(".")[4:] " from the fifth byte to the end
|
|
863 :let s = s[:-3] " remove last two bytes
|
|
864
|
685
|
865 If expr8 is a |List| this results in a new |List| with the items indicated by
|
|
866 the indexes expr1a and expr1b. This works like with a String, as explained
|
|
867 just above, except that indexes out of range cause an error. Examples: >
|
55
|
868 :let l = mylist[:3] " first four items
|
|
869 :let l = mylist[4:4] " List with one item
|
|
870 :let l = mylist[:] " shallow copy of a List
|
|
871
|
685
|
872 Using expr8[expr1] or expr8[expr1a : expr1b] on a |Funcref| results in an
|
|
873 error.
|
|
874
|
|
875
|
|
876 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary| *expr-entry*
|
|
877
|
|
878 If expr8 is a |Dictionary| and it is followed by a dot, then the following
|
|
879 name will be used as a key in the |Dictionary|. This is just like:
|
|
880 expr8[name].
|
99
|
881
|
|
882 The name must consist of alphanumeric characters, just like a variable name,
|
|
883 but it may start with a number. Curly braces cannot be used.
|
|
884
|
|
885 There must not be white space before or after the dot.
|
|
886
|
|
887 Examples: >
|
|
888 :let dict = {"one": 1, 2: "two"}
|
|
889 :echo dict.one
|
|
890 :echo dict .2
|
|
891
|
|
892 Note that the dot is also used for String concatenation. To avoid confusion
|
|
893 always put spaces around the dot for String concatenation.
|
|
894
|
|
895
|
685
|
896 expr8(expr1, ...) |Funcref| function call
|
102
|
897
|
|
898 When expr8 is a |Funcref| type variable, invoke the function it refers to.
|
|
899
|
|
900
|
|
901
|
|
902 *expr9*
|
7
|
903 number
|
|
904 ------
|
|
905 number number constant *expr-number*
|
|
906
|
|
907 Decimal, Hexadecimal (starting with 0x or 0X), or Octal (starting with 0).
|
|
908
|
|
909
|
|
910 string *expr-string* *E114*
|
|
911 ------
|
|
912 "string" string constant *expr-quote*
|
|
913
|
|
914 Note that double quotes are used.
|
|
915
|
|
916 A string constant accepts these special characters:
|
|
917 \... three-digit octal number (e.g., "\316")
|
|
918 \.. two-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
|
|
919 \. one-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
|
|
920 \x.. byte specified with two hex numbers (e.g., "\x1f")
|
|
921 \x. byte specified with one hex number (must be followed by non-hex char)
|
|
922 \X.. same as \x..
|
|
923 \X. same as \x.
|
|
924 \u.... character specified with up to 4 hex numbers, stored according to the
|
|
925 current value of 'encoding' (e.g., "\u02a4")
|
|
926 \U.... same as \u....
|
|
927 \b backspace <BS>
|
|
928 \e escape <Esc>
|
|
929 \f formfeed <FF>
|
|
930 \n newline <NL>
|
|
931 \r return <CR>
|
|
932 \t tab <Tab>
|
|
933 \\ backslash
|
|
934 \" double quote
|
|
935 \<xxx> Special key named "xxx". e.g. "\<C-W>" for CTRL-W.
|
|
936
|
|
937 Note that "\000" and "\x00" force the end of the string.
|
|
938
|
|
939
|
|
940 literal-string *literal-string* *E115*
|
|
941 ---------------
|
26
|
942 'string' string constant *expr-'*
|
7
|
943
|
|
944 Note that single quotes are used.
|
|
945
|
26
|
946 This string is taken as it is. No backslashes are removed or have a special
|
99
|
947 meaning. The only exception is that two quotes stand for one quote.
|
26
|
948
|
|
949 Single quoted strings are useful for patterns, so that backslashes do not need
|
|
950 to be doubled. These two commands are equivalent: >
|
|
951 if a =~ "\\s*"
|
|
952 if a =~ '\s*'
|
7
|
953
|
|
954
|
|
955 option *expr-option* *E112* *E113*
|
|
956 ------
|
|
957 &option option value, local value if possible
|
|
958 &g:option global option value
|
|
959 &l:option local option value
|
|
960
|
|
961 Examples: >
|
|
962 echo "tabstop is " . &tabstop
|
|
963 if &insertmode
|
|
964
|
|
965 Any option name can be used here. See |options|. When using the local value
|
|
966 and there is no buffer-local or window-local value, the global value is used
|
|
967 anyway.
|
|
968
|
|
969
|
|
970 register *expr-register*
|
|
971 --------
|
|
972 @r contents of register 'r'
|
|
973
|
|
974 The result is the contents of the named register, as a single string.
|
|
975 Newlines are inserted where required. To get the contents of the unnamed
|
336
|
976 register use @" or @@. See |registers| for an explanation of the available
|
|
977 registers.
|
|
978
|
|
979 When using the '=' register you get the expression itself, not what it
|
|
980 evaluates to. Use |eval()| to evaluate it.
|
7
|
981
|
|
982
|
|
983 nesting *expr-nesting* *E110*
|
|
984 -------
|
|
985 (expr1) nested expression
|
|
986
|
|
987
|
|
988 environment variable *expr-env*
|
|
989 --------------------
|
|
990 $VAR environment variable
|
|
991
|
|
992 The String value of any environment variable. When it is not defined, the
|
|
993 result is an empty string.
|
|
994 *expr-env-expand*
|
|
995 Note that there is a difference between using $VAR directly and using
|
|
996 expand("$VAR"). Using it directly will only expand environment variables that
|
|
997 are known inside the current Vim session. Using expand() will first try using
|
|
998 the environment variables known inside the current Vim session. If that
|
|
999 fails, a shell will be used to expand the variable. This can be slow, but it
|
|
1000 does expand all variables that the shell knows about. Example: >
|
|
1001 :echo $version
|
|
1002 :echo expand("$version")
|
|
1003 The first one probably doesn't echo anything, the second echoes the $version
|
|
1004 variable (if your shell supports it).
|
|
1005
|
|
1006
|
|
1007 internal variable *expr-variable*
|
|
1008 -----------------
|
|
1009 variable internal variable
|
|
1010 See below |internal-variables|.
|
|
1011
|
|
1012
|
170
|
1013 function call *expr-function* *E116* *E118* *E119* *E120*
|
7
|
1014 -------------
|
|
1015 function(expr1, ...) function call
|
|
1016 See below |functions|.
|
|
1017
|
|
1018
|
|
1019 ==============================================================================
|
|
1020 3. Internal variable *internal-variables* *E121*
|
|
1021 *E461*
|
|
1022 An internal variable name can be made up of letters, digits and '_'. But it
|
|
1023 cannot start with a digit. It's also possible to use curly braces, see
|
|
1024 |curly-braces-names|.
|
|
1025
|
|
1026 An internal variable is created with the ":let" command |:let|.
|
87
|
1027 An internal variable is explicitly destroyed with the ":unlet" command
|
|
1028 |:unlet|.
|
|
1029 Using a name that is not an internal variable or refers to a variable that has
|
|
1030 been destroyed results in an error.
|
7
|
1031
|
|
1032 There are several name spaces for variables. Which one is to be used is
|
|
1033 specified by what is prepended:
|
|
1034
|
|
1035 (nothing) In a function: local to a function; otherwise: global
|
|
1036 |buffer-variable| b: Local to the current buffer.
|
|
1037 |window-variable| w: Local to the current window.
|
819
|
1038 |tabpage-variable| t: Local to the current tab page.
|
7
|
1039 |global-variable| g: Global.
|
|
1040 |local-variable| l: Local to a function.
|
|
1041 |script-variable| s: Local to a |:source|'ed Vim script.
|
|
1042 |function-argument| a: Function argument (only inside a function).
|
|
1043 |vim-variable| v: Global, predefined by Vim.
|
|
1044
|
685
|
1045 The scope name by itself can be used as a |Dictionary|. For example, to
|
|
1046 delete all script-local variables: >
|
133
|
1047 :for k in keys(s:)
|
|
1048 : unlet s:[k]
|
|
1049 :endfor
|
|
1050 <
|
7
|
1051 *buffer-variable* *b:var*
|
|
1052 A variable name that is preceded with "b:" is local to the current buffer.
|
|
1053 Thus you can have several "b:foo" variables, one for each buffer.
|
|
1054 This kind of variable is deleted when the buffer is wiped out or deleted with
|
|
1055 |:bdelete|.
|
|
1056
|
|
1057 One local buffer variable is predefined:
|
|
1058 *b:changedtick-variable* *changetick*
|
|
1059 b:changedtick The total number of changes to the current buffer. It is
|
|
1060 incremented for each change. An undo command is also a change
|
|
1061 in this case. This can be used to perform an action only when
|
|
1062 the buffer has changed. Example: >
|
|
1063 :if my_changedtick != b:changedtick
|
|
1064 : let my_changedtick = b:changedtick
|
|
1065 : call My_Update()
|
|
1066 :endif
|
|
1067 <
|
|
1068 *window-variable* *w:var*
|
|
1069 A variable name that is preceded with "w:" is local to the current window. It
|
|
1070 is deleted when the window is closed.
|
|
1071
|
819
|
1072 *tabpage-variable* *t:var*
|
|
1073 A variable name that is preceded with "t:" is local to the current tab page,
|
|
1074 It is deleted when the tab page is closed. {not available when compiled
|
|
1075 without the +windows feature}
|
|
1076
|
7
|
1077 *global-variable* *g:var*
|
|
1078 Inside functions global variables are accessed with "g:". Omitting this will
|
|
1079 access a variable local to a function. But "g:" can also be used in any other
|
|
1080 place if you like.
|
|
1081
|
|
1082 *local-variable* *l:var*
|
|
1083 Inside functions local variables are accessed without prepending anything.
|
|
1084 But you can also prepend "l:" if you like.
|
|
1085
|
|
1086 *script-variable* *s:var*
|
|
1087 In a Vim script variables starting with "s:" can be used. They cannot be
|
|
1088 accessed from outside of the scripts, thus are local to the script.
|
|
1089
|
|
1090 They can be used in:
|
|
1091 - commands executed while the script is sourced
|
|
1092 - functions defined in the script
|
|
1093 - autocommands defined in the script
|
|
1094 - functions and autocommands defined in functions and autocommands which were
|
|
1095 defined in the script (recursively)
|
|
1096 - user defined commands defined in the script
|
|
1097 Thus not in:
|
|
1098 - other scripts sourced from this one
|
|
1099 - mappings
|
|
1100 - etc.
|
|
1101
|
|
1102 script variables can be used to avoid conflicts with global variable names.
|
|
1103 Take this example:
|
|
1104
|
|
1105 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1106 function MyCounter()
|
|
1107 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1108 echo s:counter
|
|
1109 endfunction
|
|
1110 command Tick call MyCounter()
|
|
1111
|
|
1112 You can now invoke "Tick" from any script, and the "s:counter" variable in
|
|
1113 that script will not be changed, only the "s:counter" in the script where
|
|
1114 "Tick" was defined is used.
|
|
1115
|
|
1116 Another example that does the same: >
|
|
1117
|
|
1118 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1119 command Tick let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | echo s:counter
|
|
1120
|
|
1121 When calling a function and invoking a user-defined command, the context for
|
9
|
1122 script variables is set to the script where the function or command was
|
7
|
1123 defined.
|
|
1124
|
|
1125 The script variables are also available when a function is defined inside a
|
|
1126 function that is defined in a script. Example: >
|
|
1127
|
|
1128 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1129 function StartCounting(incr)
|
|
1130 if a:incr
|
|
1131 function MyCounter()
|
|
1132 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1133 endfunction
|
|
1134 else
|
|
1135 function MyCounter()
|
|
1136 let s:counter = s:counter - 1
|
|
1137 endfunction
|
|
1138 endif
|
|
1139 endfunction
|
|
1140
|
|
1141 This defines the MyCounter() function either for counting up or counting down
|
|
1142 when calling StartCounting(). It doesn't matter from where StartCounting() is
|
|
1143 called, the s:counter variable will be accessible in MyCounter().
|
|
1144
|
|
1145 When the same script is sourced again it will use the same script variables.
|
|
1146 They will remain valid as long as Vim is running. This can be used to
|
|
1147 maintain a counter: >
|
|
1148
|
|
1149 if !exists("s:counter")
|
|
1150 let s:counter = 1
|
|
1151 echo "script executed for the first time"
|
|
1152 else
|
|
1153 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1154 echo "script executed " . s:counter . " times now"
|
|
1155 endif
|
|
1156
|
|
1157 Note that this means that filetype plugins don't get a different set of script
|
|
1158 variables for each buffer. Use local buffer variables instead |b:var|.
|
|
1159
|
|
1160
|
|
1161 Predefined Vim variables: *vim-variable* *v:var*
|
|
1162
|
189
|
1163 *v:beval_col* *beval_col-variable*
|
|
1164 v:beval_col The number of the column, over which the mouse pointer is.
|
|
1165 This is the byte index in the |v:beval_lnum| line.
|
|
1166 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1167
|
|
1168 *v:beval_bufnr* *beval_bufnr-variable*
|
|
1169 v:beval_bufnr The number of the buffer, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1170 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1171
|
|
1172 *v:beval_lnum* *beval_lnum-variable*
|
|
1173 v:beval_lnum The number of the line, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1174 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1175
|
|
1176 *v:beval_text* *beval_text-variable*
|
374
|
1177 v:beval_text The text under or after the mouse pointer. Usually a word as
|
|
1178 it is useful for debugging a C program. 'iskeyword' applies,
|
|
1179 but a dot and "->" before the position is included. When on a
|
|
1180 ']' the text before it is used, including the matching '[' and
|
189
|
1181 word before it. When on a Visual area within one line the
|
|
1182 highlighted text is used.
|
|
1183 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1184
|
|
1185 *v:beval_winnr* *beval_winnr-variable*
|
|
1186 v:beval_winnr The number of the window, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1187 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1188
|
7
|
1189 *v:charconvert_from* *charconvert_from-variable*
|
|
1190 v:charconvert_from
|
|
1191 The name of the character encoding of a file to be converted.
|
|
1192 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
|
|
1193
|
|
1194 *v:charconvert_to* *charconvert_to-variable*
|
|
1195 v:charconvert_to
|
|
1196 The name of the character encoding of a file after conversion.
|
|
1197 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
|
|
1198
|
|
1199 *v:cmdarg* *cmdarg-variable*
|
|
1200 v:cmdarg This variable is used for two purposes:
|
|
1201 1. The extra arguments given to a file read/write command.
|
|
1202 Currently these are "++enc=" and "++ff=". This variable is
|
|
1203 set before an autocommand event for a file read/write
|
|
1204 command is triggered. There is a leading space to make it
|
|
1205 possible to append this variable directly after the
|
|
1206 read/write command. Note: The "+cmd" argument isn't
|
|
1207 included here, because it will be executed anyway.
|
|
1208 2. When printing a PostScript file with ":hardcopy" this is
|
|
1209 the argument for the ":hardcopy" command. This can be used
|
|
1210 in 'printexpr'.
|
|
1211
|
|
1212 *v:cmdbang* *cmdbang-variable*
|
|
1213 v:cmdbang Set like v:cmdarg for a file read/write command. When a "!"
|
|
1214 was used the value is 1, otherwise it is 0. Note that this
|
|
1215 can only be used in autocommands. For user commands |<bang>|
|
|
1216 can be used.
|
|
1217
|
|
1218 *v:count* *count-variable*
|
|
1219 v:count The count given for the last Normal mode command. Can be used
|
|
1220 to get the count before a mapping. Read-only. Example: >
|
|
1221 :map _x :<C-U>echo "the count is " . v:count<CR>
|
|
1222 < Note: The <C-U> is required to remove the line range that you
|
|
1223 get when typing ':' after a count.
|
667
|
1224 Also used for evaluating the 'formatexpr' option.
|
7
|
1225 "count" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1226
|
|
1227 *v:count1* *count1-variable*
|
|
1228 v:count1 Just like "v:count", but defaults to one when no count is
|
|
1229 used.
|
|
1230
|
|
1231 *v:ctype* *ctype-variable*
|
|
1232 v:ctype The current locale setting for characters of the runtime
|
|
1233 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1234 current locale encoding. Technical: it's the value of
|
|
1235 LC_CTYPE. When not using a locale the value is "C".
|
|
1236 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1237 command.
|
|
1238 See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1239
|
|
1240 *v:dying* *dying-variable*
|
|
1241 v:dying Normally zero. When a deadly signal is caught it's set to
|
|
1242 one. When multiple signals are caught the number increases.
|
|
1243 Can be used in an autocommand to check if Vim didn't
|
|
1244 terminate normally. {only works on Unix}
|
|
1245 Example: >
|
|
1246 :au VimLeave * if v:dying | echo "\nAAAAaaaarrrggghhhh!!!\n" | endif
|
|
1247 <
|
|
1248 *v:errmsg* *errmsg-variable*
|
|
1249 v:errmsg Last given error message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1250 Example: >
|
|
1251 :let v:errmsg = ""
|
|
1252 :silent! next
|
|
1253 :if v:errmsg != ""
|
|
1254 : ... handle error
|
|
1255 < "errmsg" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1256
|
|
1257 *v:exception* *exception-variable*
|
|
1258 v:exception The value of the exception most recently caught and not
|
|
1259 finished. See also |v:throwpoint| and |throw-variables|.
|
|
1260 Example: >
|
|
1261 :try
|
|
1262 : throw "oops"
|
|
1263 :catch /.*/
|
|
1264 : echo "caught" v:exception
|
|
1265 :endtry
|
|
1266 < Output: "caught oops".
|
|
1267
|
179
|
1268 *v:fcs_reason* *fcs_reason-variable*
|
|
1269 v:fcs_reason The reason why the |FileChangedShell| event was triggered.
|
|
1270 Can be used in an autocommand to decide what to do and/or what
|
|
1271 to set v:fcs_choice to. Possible values:
|
|
1272 deleted file no longer exists
|
|
1273 conflict file contents, mode or timestamp was
|
|
1274 changed and buffer is modified
|
|
1275 changed file contents has changed
|
|
1276 mode mode of file changed
|
|
1277 time only file timestamp changed
|
|
1278
|
|
1279 *v:fcs_choice* *fcs_choice-variable*
|
|
1280 v:fcs_choice What should happen after a |FileChangedShell| event was
|
|
1281 triggered. Can be used in an autocommand to tell Vim what to
|
|
1282 do with the affected buffer:
|
|
1283 reload Reload the buffer (does not work if
|
|
1284 the file was deleted).
|
|
1285 ask Ask the user what to do, as if there
|
|
1286 was no autocommand. Except that when
|
|
1287 only the timestamp changed nothing
|
|
1288 will happen.
|
|
1289 <empty> Nothing, the autocommand should do
|
|
1290 everything that needs to be done.
|
|
1291 The default is empty. If another (invalid) value is used then
|
|
1292 Vim behaves like it is empty, there is no warning message.
|
|
1293
|
7
|
1294 *v:fname_in* *fname_in-variable*
|
579
|
1295 v:fname_in The name of the input file. Valid while evaluating:
|
7
|
1296 option used for ~
|
|
1297 'charconvert' file to be converted
|
|
1298 'diffexpr' original file
|
|
1299 'patchexpr' original file
|
|
1300 'printexpr' file to be printed
|
593
|
1301 And set to the swap file name for |SwapExists|.
|
7
|
1302
|
|
1303 *v:fname_out* *fname_out-variable*
|
|
1304 v:fname_out The name of the output file. Only valid while
|
|
1305 evaluating:
|
|
1306 option used for ~
|
|
1307 'charconvert' resulting converted file (*)
|
|
1308 'diffexpr' output of diff
|
|
1309 'patchexpr' resulting patched file
|
|
1310 (*) When doing conversion for a write command (e.g., ":w
|
|
1311 file") it will be equal to v:fname_in. When doing conversion
|
|
1312 for a read command (e.g., ":e file") it will be a temporary
|
|
1313 file and different from v:fname_in.
|
|
1314
|
|
1315 *v:fname_new* *fname_new-variable*
|
|
1316 v:fname_new The name of the new version of the file. Only valid while
|
|
1317 evaluating 'diffexpr'.
|
|
1318
|
|
1319 *v:fname_diff* *fname_diff-variable*
|
|
1320 v:fname_diff The name of the diff (patch) file. Only valid while
|
|
1321 evaluating 'patchexpr'.
|
|
1322
|
|
1323 *v:folddashes* *folddashes-variable*
|
|
1324 v:folddashes Used for 'foldtext': dashes representing foldlevel of a closed
|
|
1325 fold.
|
29
|
1326 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1327
|
|
1328 *v:foldlevel* *foldlevel-variable*
|
|
1329 v:foldlevel Used for 'foldtext': foldlevel of closed fold.
|
29
|
1330 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1331
|
|
1332 *v:foldend* *foldend-variable*
|
|
1333 v:foldend Used for 'foldtext': last line of closed fold.
|
29
|
1334 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1335
|
|
1336 *v:foldstart* *foldstart-variable*
|
|
1337 v:foldstart Used for 'foldtext': first line of closed fold.
|
29
|
1338 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1339
|
11
|
1340 *v:insertmode* *insertmode-variable*
|
|
1341 v:insertmode Used for the |InsertEnter| and |InsertChange| autocommand
|
|
1342 events. Values:
|
|
1343 i Insert mode
|
|
1344 r Replace mode
|
|
1345 v Virtual Replace mode
|
|
1346
|
102
|
1347 *v:key* *key-variable*
|
685
|
1348 v:key Key of the current item of a |Dictionary|. Only valid while
|
102
|
1349 evaluating the expression used with |map()| and |filter()|.
|
|
1350 Read-only.
|
|
1351
|
7
|
1352 *v:lang* *lang-variable*
|
|
1353 v:lang The current locale setting for messages of the runtime
|
|
1354 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1355 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_MESSAGES.
|
|
1356 The value is system dependent.
|
|
1357 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1358 command.
|
|
1359 It can be different from |v:ctype| when messages are desired
|
|
1360 in a different language than what is used for character
|
|
1361 encoding. See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1362
|
|
1363 *v:lc_time* *lc_time-variable*
|
|
1364 v:lc_time The current locale setting for time messages of the runtime
|
|
1365 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1366 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_TIME.
|
|
1367 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1368 command. See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1369
|
|
1370 *v:lnum* *lnum-variable*
|
29
|
1371 v:lnum Line number for the 'foldexpr' |fold-expr| and 'indentexpr'
|
688
|
1372 expressions, tab page number for 'guitablabel'. Only valid
|
|
1373 while one of these expressions is being evaluated. Read-only
|
|
1374 when in the |sandbox|.
|
7
|
1375
|
|
1376 *v:prevcount* *prevcount-variable*
|
|
1377 v:prevcount The count given for the last but one Normal mode command.
|
|
1378 This is the v:count value of the previous command. Useful if
|
|
1379 you want to cancel Visual mode and then use the count. >
|
|
1380 :vmap % <Esc>:call MyFilter(v:prevcount)<CR>
|
|
1381 < Read-only.
|
|
1382
|
170
|
1383 *v:profiling* *profiling-variable*
|
|
1384 v:profiling Normally zero. Set to one after using ":profile start".
|
|
1385 See |profiling|.
|
|
1386
|
7
|
1387 *v:progname* *progname-variable*
|
|
1388 v:progname Contains the name (with path removed) with which Vim was
|
|
1389 invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for "view",
|
|
1390 "evim" etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim.
|
|
1391 Read-only.
|
|
1392
|
|
1393 *v:register* *register-variable*
|
|
1394 v:register The name of the register supplied to the last normal mode
|
|
1395 command. Empty if none were supplied. |getreg()| |setreg()|
|
|
1396
|
540
|
1397 *v:scrollstart* *scrollstart-variable*
|
|
1398 v:scrollstart String describing the script or function that caused the
|
|
1399 screen to scroll up. It's only set when it is empty, thus the
|
|
1400 first reason is remembered. It is set to "Unknown" for a
|
|
1401 typed command.
|
|
1402 This can be used to find out why your script causes the
|
|
1403 hit-enter prompt.
|
|
1404
|
7
|
1405 *v:servername* *servername-variable*
|
|
1406 v:servername The resulting registered |x11-clientserver| name if any.
|
|
1407 Read-only.
|
|
1408
|
|
1409 *v:shell_error* *shell_error-variable*
|
|
1410 v:shell_error Result of the last shell command. When non-zero, the last
|
|
1411 shell command had an error. When zero, there was no problem.
|
|
1412 This only works when the shell returns the error code to Vim.
|
|
1413 The value -1 is often used when the command could not be
|
|
1414 executed. Read-only.
|
|
1415 Example: >
|
|
1416 :!mv foo bar
|
|
1417 :if v:shell_error
|
|
1418 : echo 'could not rename "foo" to "bar"!'
|
|
1419 :endif
|
|
1420 < "shell_error" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1421
|
|
1422 *v:statusmsg* *statusmsg-variable*
|
|
1423 v:statusmsg Last given status message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1424
|
579
|
1425 *v:swapname* *swapname-variable*
|
|
1426 v:swapname Only valid when executing |SwapExists| autocommands: Name of
|
|
1427 the swap file found. Read-only.
|
|
1428
|
|
1429 *v:swapchoice* *swapchoice-variable*
|
|
1430 v:swapchoice |SwapExists| autocommands can set this to the selected choice
|
|
1431 for handling an existing swap file:
|
|
1432 'o' Open read-only
|
|
1433 'e' Edit anyway
|
|
1434 'r' Recover
|
|
1435 'd' Delete swapfile
|
|
1436 'q' Quit
|
|
1437 'a' Abort
|
|
1438 The value should be a single-character string. An empty value
|
|
1439 results in the user being asked, as would happen when there is
|
|
1440 no SwapExists autocommand. The default is empty.
|
|
1441
|
590
|
1442 *v:swapcommand* *swapcommand-variable*
|
625
|
1443 v:swapcommand Normal mode command to be executed after a file has been
|
590
|
1444 opened. Can be used for a |SwapExists| autocommand to have
|
|
1445 another Vim open the file and jump to the right place. For
|
|
1446 example, when jumping to a tag the value is ":tag tagname\r".
|
716
|
1447 For ":edit +cmd file" the value is ":cmd\r".
|
590
|
1448
|
7
|
1449 *v:termresponse* *termresponse-variable*
|
|
1450 v:termresponse The escape sequence returned by the terminal for the |t_RV|
|
|
1451 termcap entry. It is set when Vim receives an escape sequence
|
|
1452 that starts with ESC [ or CSI and ends in a 'c', with only
|
|
1453 digits, ';' and '.' in between.
|
|
1454 When this option is set, the TermResponse autocommand event is
|
|
1455 fired, so that you can react to the response from the
|
|
1456 terminal.
|
|
1457 The response from a new xterm is: "<Esc>[ Pp ; Pv ; Pc c". Pp
|
|
1458 is the terminal type: 0 for vt100 and 1 for vt220. Pv is the
|
|
1459 patch level (since this was introduced in patch 95, it's
|
|
1460 always 95 or bigger). Pc is always zero.
|
|
1461 {only when compiled with |+termresponse| feature}
|
|
1462
|
|
1463 *v:this_session* *this_session-variable*
|
|
1464 v:this_session Full filename of the last loaded or saved session file. See
|
|
1465 |:mksession|. It is allowed to set this variable. When no
|
|
1466 session file has been saved, this variable is empty.
|
|
1467 "this_session" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1468
|
|
1469 *v:throwpoint* *throwpoint-variable*
|
|
1470 v:throwpoint The point where the exception most recently caught and not
|
|
1471 finished was thrown. Not set when commands are typed. See
|
|
1472 also |v:exception| and |throw-variables|.
|
|
1473 Example: >
|
|
1474 :try
|
|
1475 : throw "oops"
|
|
1476 :catch /.*/
|
|
1477 : echo "Exception from" v:throwpoint
|
|
1478 :endtry
|
|
1479 < Output: "Exception from test.vim, line 2"
|
|
1480
|
102
|
1481 *v:val* *val-variable*
|
685
|
1482 v:val Value of the current item of a |List| or |Dictionary|. Only
|
|
1483 valid while evaluating the expression used with |map()| and
|
102
|
1484 |filter()|. Read-only.
|
|
1485
|
7
|
1486 *v:version* *version-variable*
|
|
1487 v:version Version number of Vim: Major version number times 100 plus
|
|
1488 minor version number. Version 5.0 is 500. Version 5.1 (5.01)
|
|
1489 is 501. Read-only. "version" also works, for backwards
|
|
1490 compatibility.
|
|
1491 Use |has()| to check if a certain patch was included, e.g.: >
|
|
1492 if has("patch123")
|
|
1493 < Note that patch numbers are specific to the version, thus both
|
|
1494 version 5.0 and 5.1 may have a patch 123, but these are
|
|
1495 completely different.
|
|
1496
|
|
1497 *v:warningmsg* *warningmsg-variable*
|
|
1498 v:warningmsg Last given warning message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1499
|
|
1500 ==============================================================================
|
|
1501 4. Builtin Functions *functions*
|
|
1502
|
|
1503 See |function-list| for a list grouped by what the function is used for.
|
|
1504
|
236
|
1505 (Use CTRL-] on the function name to jump to the full explanation.)
|
7
|
1506
|
|
1507 USAGE RESULT DESCRIPTION ~
|
|
1508
|
685
|
1509 add( {list}, {item}) List append {item} to |List| {list}
|
55
|
1510 append( {lnum}, {string}) Number append {string} below line {lnum}
|
161
|
1511 append( {lnum}, {list}) Number append lines {list} below line {lnum}
|
7
|
1512 argc() Number number of files in the argument list
|
55
|
1513 argidx() Number current index in the argument list
|
7
|
1514 argv( {nr}) String {nr} entry of the argument list
|
818
|
1515 argv( ) List the argument list
|
7
|
1516 browse( {save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
|
|
1517 String put up a file requester
|
29
|
1518 browsedir( {title}, {initdir}) String put up a directory requester
|
7
|
1519 bufexists( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} exists
|
55
|
1520 buflisted( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is listed
|
|
1521 bufloaded( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is loaded
|
7
|
1522 bufname( {expr}) String Name of the buffer {expr}
|
|
1523 bufnr( {expr}) Number Number of the buffer {expr}
|
|
1524 bufwinnr( {expr}) Number window number of buffer {expr}
|
|
1525 byte2line( {byte}) Number line number at byte count {byte}
|
55
|
1526 byteidx( {expr}, {nr}) Number byte index of {nr}'th char in {expr}
|
102
|
1527 call( {func}, {arglist} [, {dict}])
|
|
1528 any call {func} with arguments {arglist}
|
777
|
1529 changenr() Number current change number
|
7
|
1530 char2nr( {expr}) Number ASCII value of first char in {expr}
|
55
|
1531 cindent( {lnum}) Number C indent for line {lnum}
|
7
|
1532 col( {expr}) Number column nr of cursor or mark
|
724
|
1533 complete({startcol}, {matches}) String set Insert mode completion
|
464
|
1534 complete_add( {expr}) Number add completion match
|
|
1535 complete_check() Number check for key typed during completion
|
7
|
1536 confirm( {msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
|
|
1537 Number number of choice picked by user
|
55
|
1538 copy( {expr}) any make a shallow copy of {expr}
|
95
|
1539 count( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
|
|
1540 Number count how many {expr} are in {list}
|
7
|
1541 cscope_connection( [{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
|
|
1542 Number checks existence of cscope connection
|
703
|
1543 cursor( {lnum}, {col} [, {coladd}])
|
|
1544 Number move cursor to {lnum}, {col}, {coladd}
|
|
1545 cursor( {list}) Number move cursor to position in {list}
|
55
|
1546 deepcopy( {expr}) any make a full copy of {expr}
|
7
|
1547 delete( {fname}) Number delete file {fname}
|
|
1548 did_filetype() Number TRUE if FileType autocommand event used
|
55
|
1549 diff_filler( {lnum}) Number diff filler lines about {lnum}
|
|
1550 diff_hlID( {lnum}, {col}) Number diff highlighting at {lnum}/{col}
|
85
|
1551 empty( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is empty
|
7
|
1552 escape( {string}, {chars}) String escape {chars} in {string} with '\'
|
205
|
1553 eval( {string}) any evaluate {string} into its value
|
55
|
1554 eventhandler( ) Number TRUE if inside an event handler
|
7
|
1555 executable( {expr}) Number 1 if executable {expr} exists
|
|
1556 exists( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} exists
|
824
|
1557 extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}])
|
|
1558 List/Dict insert items of {expr2} into {expr1}
|
7
|
1559 expand( {expr}) String expand special keywords in {expr}
|
|
1560 filereadable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a readable file
|
824
|
1561 filewritable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a writable file
|
102
|
1562 filter( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict remove items from {expr} where
|
|
1563 {string} is 0
|
95
|
1564 finddir( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
|
824
|
1565 String find directory {name} in {path}
|
19
|
1566 findfile( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
|
824
|
1567 String find file {name} in {path}
|
7
|
1568 fnamemodify( {fname}, {mods}) String modify file name
|
55
|
1569 foldclosed( {lnum}) Number first line of fold at {lnum} if closed
|
|
1570 foldclosedend( {lnum}) Number last line of fold at {lnum} if closed
|
7
|
1571 foldlevel( {lnum}) Number fold level at {lnum}
|
55
|
1572 foldtext( ) String line displayed for closed fold
|
824
|
1573 foldtextresult( {lnum}) String text for closed fold at {lnum}
|
7
|
1574 foreground( ) Number bring the Vim window to the foreground
|
55
|
1575 function( {name}) Funcref reference to function {name}
|
824
|
1576 garbagecollect() none free memory, breaking cyclic references
|
82
|
1577 get( {list}, {idx} [, {def}]) any get item {idx} from {list} or {def}
|
102
|
1578 get( {dict}, {key} [, {def}]) any get item {key} from {dict} or {def}
|
435
|
1579 getbufline( {expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
|
|
1580 List lines {lnum} to {end} of buffer {expr}
|
824
|
1581 getbufvar( {expr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in buffer {expr}
|
55
|
1582 getchar( [expr]) Number get one character from the user
|
|
1583 getcharmod( ) Number modifiers for the last typed character
|
7
|
1584 getcmdline() String return the current command-line
|
|
1585 getcmdpos() Number return cursor position in command-line
|
531
|
1586 getcmdtype() String return the current command-line type
|
7
|
1587 getcwd() String the current working directory
|
20
|
1588 getfperm( {fname}) String file permissions of file {fname}
|
|
1589 getfsize( {fname}) Number size in bytes of file {fname}
|
37
|
1590 getfontname( [{name}]) String name of font being used
|
7
|
1591 getftime( {fname}) Number last modification time of file
|
20
|
1592 getftype( {fname}) String description of type of file {fname}
|
161
|
1593 getline( {lnum}) String line {lnum} of current buffer
|
|
1594 getline( {lnum}, {end}) List lines {lnum} to {end} of current buffer
|
647
|
1595 getloclist({nr}) List list of location list items
|
703
|
1596 getpos( {expr}) List position of cursor, mark, etc.
|
230
|
1597 getqflist() List list of quickfix items
|
282
|
1598 getreg( [{regname} [, 1]]) String contents of register
|
55
|
1599 getregtype( [{regname}]) String type of register
|
831
|
1600 gettabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {name})
|
|
1601 any {name} in {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}
|
7
|
1602 getwinposx() Number X coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
|
|
1603 getwinposy() Number Y coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
|
824
|
1604 getwinvar( {nr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in window {nr}
|
7
|
1605 glob( {expr}) String expand file wildcards in {expr}
|
|
1606 globpath( {path}, {expr}) String do glob({expr}) for all dirs in {path}
|
|
1607 has( {feature}) Number TRUE if feature {feature} supported
|
102
|
1608 has_key( {dict}, {key}) Number TRUE if {dict} has entry {key}
|
782
|
1609 hasmapto( {what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1610 Number TRUE if mapping to {what} exists
|
7
|
1611 histadd( {history},{item}) String add an item to a history
|
|
1612 histdel( {history} [, {item}]) String remove an item from a history
|
|
1613 histget( {history} [, {index}]) String get the item {index} from a history
|
|
1614 histnr( {history}) Number highest index of a history
|
|
1615 hlexists( {name}) Number TRUE if highlight group {name} exists
|
|
1616 hlID( {name}) Number syntax ID of highlight group {name}
|
|
1617 hostname() String name of the machine Vim is running on
|
55
|
1618 iconv( {expr}, {from}, {to}) String convert encoding of {expr}
|
|
1619 indent( {lnum}) Number indent of line {lnum}
|
95
|
1620 index( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
|
|
1621 Number index in {list} where {expr} appears
|
531
|
1622 input( {prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]])
|
|
1623 String get input from the user
|
7
|
1624 inputdialog( {p} [, {t} [, {c}]]) String like input() but in a GUI dialog
|
824
|
1625 inputlist( {textlist}) Number let the user pick from a choice list
|
55
|
1626 inputrestore() Number restore typeahead
|
|
1627 inputsave() Number save and clear typeahead
|
7
|
1628 inputsecret( {prompt} [, {text}]) String like input() but hiding the text
|
55
|
1629 insert( {list}, {item} [, {idx}]) List insert {item} in {list} [before {idx}]
|
7
|
1630 isdirectory( {directory}) Number TRUE if {directory} is a directory
|
148
|
1631 islocked( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is locked
|
685
|
1632 items( {dict}) List key-value pairs in {dict}
|
95
|
1633 join( {list} [, {sep}]) String join {list} items into one String
|
685
|
1634 keys( {dict}) List keys in {dict}
|
55
|
1635 len( {expr}) Number the length of {expr}
|
|
1636 libcall( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) String call {func} in library {lib} with {arg}
|
7
|
1637 libcallnr( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) Number idem, but return a Number
|
|
1638 line( {expr}) Number line nr of cursor, last line or mark
|
|
1639 line2byte( {lnum}) Number byte count of line {lnum}
|
55
|
1640 lispindent( {lnum}) Number Lisp indent for line {lnum}
|
7
|
1641 localtime() Number current time
|
102
|
1642 map( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict change each item in {expr} to {expr}
|
782
|
1643 maparg( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1644 String rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}
|
|
1645 mapcheck( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1646 String check for mappings matching {name}
|
19
|
1647 match( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
7
|
1648 Number position where {pat} matches in {expr}
|
819
|
1649 matcharg( {nr}) List arguments of |:match|
|
19
|
1650 matchend( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
7
|
1651 Number position where {pat} ends in {expr}
|
158
|
1652 matchlist( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
|
1653 List match and submatches of {pat} in {expr}
|
19
|
1654 matchstr( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
|
1655 String {count}'th match of {pat} in {expr}
|
87
|
1656 max({list}) Number maximum value of items in {list}
|
|
1657 min({list}) Number minumum value of items in {list}
|
168
|
1658 mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
|
|
1659 Number create directory {name}
|
55
|
1660 mode() String current editing mode
|
7
|
1661 nextnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line >= {lnum}
|
|
1662 nr2char( {expr}) String single char with ASCII value {expr}
|
819
|
1663 pathshorten( {expr}) String shorten directory names in a path
|
7
|
1664 prevnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line <= {lnum}
|
449
|
1665 printf( {fmt}, {expr1}...) String format text
|
667
|
1666 pumvisible() Number whether popup menu is visible
|
99
|
1667 range( {expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]])
|
|
1668 List items from {expr} to {max}
|
168
|
1669 readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
|
|
1670 List get list of lines from file {fname}
|
794
|
1671 reltime( [{start} [, {end}]]) List get time value
|
|
1672 reltimestr( {time}) String turn time value into a String
|
7
|
1673 remote_expr( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
1674 String send expression
|
|
1675 remote_foreground( {server}) Number bring Vim server to the foreground
|
|
1676 remote_peek( {serverid} [, {retvar}])
|
|
1677 Number check for reply string
|
|
1678 remote_read( {serverid}) String read reply string
|
|
1679 remote_send( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
1680 String send key sequence
|
79
|
1681 remove( {list}, {idx} [, {end}]) any remove items {idx}-{end} from {list}
|
99
|
1682 remove( {dict}, {key}) any remove entry {key} from {dict}
|
55
|
1683 rename( {from}, {to}) Number rename (move) file from {from} to {to}
|
|
1684 repeat( {expr}, {count}) String repeat {expr} {count} times
|
|
1685 resolve( {filename}) String get filename a shortcut points to
|
82
|
1686 reverse( {list}) List reverse {list} in-place
|
55
|
1687 search( {pattern} [, {flags}]) Number search for {pattern}
|
523
|
1688 searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]])
|
|
1689 Number search for variable declaration
|
692
|
1690 searchpair( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
55
|
1691 Number search for other end of start/end pair
|
692
|
1692 searchpairpos( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
667
|
1693 List search for other end of start/end pair
|
692
|
1694 searchpos( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]])
|
667
|
1695 List search for {pattern}
|
7
|
1696 server2client( {clientid}, {string})
|
|
1697 Number send reply string
|
|
1698 serverlist() String get a list of available servers
|
|
1699 setbufvar( {expr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in buffer {expr} to {val}
|
|
1700 setcmdpos( {pos}) Number set cursor position in command-line
|
|
1701 setline( {lnum}, {line}) Number set line {lnum} to {line}
|
647
|
1702 setloclist( {nr}, {list}[, {action}])
|
|
1703 Number modify location list using {list}
|
824
|
1704 setpos( {expr}, {list}) none set the {expr} position to {list}
|
647
|
1705 setqflist( {list}[, {action}]) Number modify quickfix list using {list}
|
55
|
1706 setreg( {n}, {v}[, {opt}]) Number set register to value and type
|
831
|
1707 settabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window
|
|
1708 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr} to {val}
|
7
|
1709 setwinvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window {nr} to {val}
|
55
|
1710 simplify( {filename}) String simplify filename as much as possible
|
82
|
1711 sort( {list} [, {func}]) List sort {list}, using {func} to compare
|
374
|
1712 soundfold( {word}) String sound-fold {word}
|
344
|
1713 spellbadword() String badly spelled word at cursor
|
537
|
1714 spellsuggest( {word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
|
|
1715 List spelling suggestions
|
282
|
1716 split( {expr} [, {pat} [, {keepempty}]])
|
685
|
1717 List make |List| from {pat} separated {expr}
|
782
|
1718 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) Number convert string to number
|
7
|
1719 strftime( {format}[, {time}]) String time in specified format
|
133
|
1720 stridx( {haystack}, {needle}[, {start}])
|
|
1721 Number index of {needle} in {haystack}
|
95
|
1722 string( {expr}) String String representation of {expr} value
|
7
|
1723 strlen( {expr}) Number length of the String {expr}
|
|
1724 strpart( {src}, {start}[, {len}])
|
|
1725 String {len} characters of {src} at {start}
|
140
|
1726 strridx( {haystack}, {needle} [, {start}])
|
|
1727 Number last index of {needle} in {haystack}
|
7
|
1728 strtrans( {expr}) String translate string to make it printable
|
55
|
1729 submatch( {nr}) String specific match in ":substitute"
|
7
|
1730 substitute( {expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags})
|
|
1731 String all {pat} in {expr} replaced with {sub}
|
32
|
1732 synID( {lnum}, {col}, {trans}) Number syntax ID at {lnum} and {col}
|
7
|
1733 synIDattr( {synID}, {what} [, {mode}])
|
|
1734 String attribute {what} of syntax ID {synID}
|
|
1735 synIDtrans( {synID}) Number translated syntax ID of {synID}
|
24
|
1736 system( {expr} [, {input}]) String output of shell command/filter {expr}
|
677
|
1737 tabpagebuflist( [{arg}]) List list of buffer numbers in tab page
|
|
1738 tabpagenr( [{arg}]) Number number of current or last tab page
|
|
1739 tabpagewinnr( {tabarg}[, {arg}])
|
|
1740 Number number of current window in tab page
|
|
1741 taglist( {expr}) List list of tags matching {expr}
|
515
|
1742 tagfiles() List tags files used
|
7
|
1743 tempname() String name for a temporary file
|
|
1744 tolower( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to lowercase
|
|
1745 toupper( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to uppercase
|
15
|
1746 tr( {src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) String translate chars of {src} in {fromstr}
|
|
1747 to chars in {tostr}
|
7
|
1748 type( {name}) Number type of variable {name}
|
685
|
1749 values( {dict}) List values in {dict}
|
7
|
1750 virtcol( {expr}) Number screen column of cursor or mark
|
|
1751 visualmode( [expr]) String last visual mode used
|
|
1752 winbufnr( {nr}) Number buffer number of window {nr}
|
|
1753 wincol() Number window column of the cursor
|
|
1754 winheight( {nr}) Number height of window {nr}
|
|
1755 winline() Number window line of the cursor
|
674
|
1756 winnr( [{expr}]) Number number of current window
|
55
|
1757 winrestcmd() String returns command to restore window sizes
|
712
|
1758 winrestview({dict}) None restore view of current window
|
|
1759 winsaveview() Dict save view of current window
|
7
|
1760 winwidth( {nr}) Number width of window {nr}
|
158
|
1761 writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
|
|
1762 Number write list of lines to file {fname}
|
7
|
1763
|
82
|
1764 add({list}, {expr}) *add()*
|
685
|
1765 Append the item {expr} to |List| {list}. Returns the
|
|
1766 resulting |List|. Examples: >
|
82
|
1767 :let alist = add([1, 2, 3], item)
|
|
1768 :call add(mylist, "woodstock")
|
685
|
1769 < Note that when {expr} is a |List| it is appended as a single
|
692
|
1770 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
|
85
|
1771 Use |insert()| to add an item at another position.
|
55
|
1772
|
82
|
1773
|
|
1774 append({lnum}, {expr}) *append()*
|
685
|
1775 When {expr} is a |List|: Append each item of the |List| as a
|
|
1776 text line below line {lnum} in the current buffer.
|
153
|
1777 Otherwise append {expr} as one text line below line {lnum} in
|
|
1778 the current buffer.
|
|
1779 {lnum} can be zero to insert a line before the first one.
|
82
|
1780 Returns 1 for failure ({lnum} out of range or out of memory),
|
|
1781 0 for success. Example: >
|
55
|
1782 :let failed = append(line('$'), "# THE END")
|
82
|
1783 :let failed = append(0, ["Chapter 1", "the beginning"])
|
55
|
1784 <
|
7
|
1785 *argc()*
|
|
1786 argc() The result is the number of files in the argument list of the
|
|
1787 current window. See |arglist|.
|
|
1788
|
|
1789 *argidx()*
|
|
1790 argidx() The result is the current index in the argument list. 0 is
|
|
1791 the first file. argc() - 1 is the last one. See |arglist|.
|
|
1792
|
|
1793 *argv()*
|
818
|
1794 argv([{nr}]) The result is the {nr}th file in the argument list of the
|
7
|
1795 current window. See |arglist|. "argv(0)" is the first one.
|
|
1796 Example: >
|
|
1797 :let i = 0
|
|
1798 :while i < argc()
|
|
1799 : let f = escape(argv(i), '. ')
|
|
1800 : exe 'amenu Arg.' . f . ' :e ' . f . '<CR>'
|
|
1801 : let i = i + 1
|
|
1802 :endwhile
|
818
|
1803 < Without the {nr} argument a |List| with the whole |arglist| is
|
|
1804 returned.
|
|
1805
|
7
|
1806 *browse()*
|
|
1807 browse({save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
|
|
1808 Put up a file requester. This only works when "has("browse")"
|
|
1809 returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
|
|
1810 The input fields are:
|
|
1811 {save} when non-zero, select file to write
|
|
1812 {title} title for the requester
|
|
1813 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
|
|
1814 {default} default file name
|
|
1815 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
|
|
1816 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
|
|
1817
|
29
|
1818 *browsedir()*
|
|
1819 browsedir({title}, {initdir})
|
|
1820 Put up a directory requester. This only works when
|
|
1821 "has("browse")" returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
|
|
1822 On systems where a directory browser is not supported a file
|
|
1823 browser is used. In that case: select a file in the directory
|
|
1824 to be used.
|
|
1825 The input fields are:
|
|
1826 {title} title for the requester
|
|
1827 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
|
|
1828 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
|
|
1829 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
|
|
1830
|
7
|
1831 bufexists({expr}) *bufexists()*
|
|
1832 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1833 {expr} exists.
|
9
|
1834 If the {expr} argument is a number, buffer numbers are used.
|
7
|
1835 If the {expr} argument is a string it must match a buffer name
|
9
|
1836 exactly. The name can be:
|
|
1837 - Relative to the current directory.
|
|
1838 - A full path.
|
|
1839 - The name of a buffer with 'filetype' set to "nofile".
|
|
1840 - A URL name.
|
7
|
1841 Unlisted buffers will be found.
|
|
1842 Note that help files are listed by their short name in the
|
|
1843 output of |:buffers|, but bufexists() requires using their
|
|
1844 long name to be able to find them.
|
|
1845 Use "bufexists(0)" to test for the existence of an alternate
|
|
1846 file name.
|
|
1847 *buffer_exists()*
|
|
1848 Obsolete name: buffer_exists().
|
|
1849
|
|
1850 buflisted({expr}) *buflisted()*
|
|
1851 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1852 {expr} exists and is listed (has the 'buflisted' option set).
|
9
|
1853 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
|
7
|
1854
|
|
1855 bufloaded({expr}) *bufloaded()*
|
|
1856 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1857 {expr} exists and is loaded (shown in a window or hidden).
|
9
|
1858 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
|
7
|
1859
|
|
1860 bufname({expr}) *bufname()*
|
|
1861 The result is the name of a buffer, as it is displayed by the
|
|
1862 ":ls" command.
|
|
1863 If {expr} is a Number, that buffer number's name is given.
|
|
1864 Number zero is the alternate buffer for the current window.
|
|
1865 If {expr} is a String, it is used as a |file-pattern| to match
|
|
1866 with the buffer names. This is always done like 'magic' is
|
|
1867 set and 'cpoptions' is empty. When there is more than one
|
|
1868 match an empty string is returned.
|
|
1869 "" or "%" can be used for the current buffer, "#" for the
|
|
1870 alternate buffer.
|
|
1871 A full match is preferred, otherwise a match at the start, end
|
|
1872 or middle of the buffer name is accepted.
|
|
1873 Listed buffers are found first. If there is a single match
|
|
1874 with a listed buffer, that one is returned. Next unlisted
|
|
1875 buffers are searched for.
|
|
1876 If the {expr} is a String, but you want to use it as a buffer
|
|
1877 number, force it to be a Number by adding zero to it: >
|
|
1878 :echo bufname("3" + 0)
|
|
1879 < If the buffer doesn't exist, or doesn't have a name, an empty
|
|
1880 string is returned. >
|
|
1881 bufname("#") alternate buffer name
|
|
1882 bufname(3) name of buffer 3
|
|
1883 bufname("%") name of current buffer
|
|
1884 bufname("file2") name of buffer where "file2" matches.
|
|
1885 < *buffer_name()*
|
|
1886 Obsolete name: buffer_name().
|
|
1887
|
|
1888 *bufnr()*
|
707
|
1889 bufnr({expr} [, {create}])
|
|
1890 The result is the number of a buffer, as it is displayed by
|
7
|
1891 the ":ls" command. For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()|
|
707
|
1892 above.
|
|
1893 If the buffer doesn't exist, -1 is returned. Or, if the
|
|
1894 {create} argument is present and not zero, a new, unlisted,
|
|
1895 buffer is created and its number is returned.
|
7
|
1896 bufnr("$") is the last buffer: >
|
|
1897 :let last_buffer = bufnr("$")
|
|
1898 < The result is a Number, which is the highest buffer number
|
|
1899 of existing buffers. Note that not all buffers with a smaller
|
|
1900 number necessarily exist, because ":bwipeout" may have removed
|
|
1901 them. Use bufexists() to test for the existence of a buffer.
|
|
1902 *buffer_number()*
|
|
1903 Obsolete name: buffer_number().
|
|
1904 *last_buffer_nr()*
|
|
1905 Obsolete name for bufnr("$"): last_buffer_nr().
|
|
1906
|
|
1907 bufwinnr({expr}) *bufwinnr()*
|
|
1908 The result is a Number, which is the number of the first
|
|
1909 window associated with buffer {expr}. For the use of {expr},
|
|
1910 see |bufname()| above. If buffer {expr} doesn't exist or
|
|
1911 there is no such window, -1 is returned. Example: >
|
|
1912
|
|
1913 echo "A window containing buffer 1 is " . (bufwinnr(1))
|
|
1914
|
|
1915 < The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
|
|
1916 |:wincmd|.
|
|
1917
|
|
1918
|
|
1919 byte2line({byte}) *byte2line()*
|
|
1920 Return the line number that contains the character at byte
|
|
1921 count {byte} in the current buffer. This includes the
|
|
1922 end-of-line character, depending on the 'fileformat' option
|
|
1923 for the current buffer. The first character has byte count
|
|
1924 one.
|
|
1925 Also see |line2byte()|, |go| and |:goto|.
|
|
1926 {not available when compiled without the |+byte_offset|
|
|
1927 feature}
|
|
1928
|
18
|
1929 byteidx({expr}, {nr}) *byteidx()*
|
|
1930 Return byte index of the {nr}'th character in the string
|
|
1931 {expr}. Use zero for the first character, it returns zero.
|
|
1932 This function is only useful when there are multibyte
|
|
1933 characters, otherwise the returned value is equal to {nr}.
|
|
1934 Composing characters are counted as a separate character.
|
|
1935 Example : >
|
|
1936 echo matchstr(str, ".", byteidx(str, 3))
|
|
1937 < will display the fourth character. Another way to do the
|
|
1938 same: >
|
|
1939 let s = strpart(str, byteidx(str, 3))
|
|
1940 echo strpart(s, 0, byteidx(s, 1))
|
|
1941 < If there are less than {nr} characters -1 is returned.
|
|
1942 If there are exactly {nr} characters the length of the string
|
|
1943 is returned.
|
|
1944
|
102
|
1945 call({func}, {arglist} [, {dict}]) *call()* *E699*
|
685
|
1946 Call function {func} with the items in |List| {arglist} as
|
79
|
1947 arguments.
|
685
|
1948 {func} can either be a |Funcref| or the name of a function.
|
79
|
1949 a:firstline and a:lastline are set to the cursor line.
|
|
1950 Returns the return value of the called function.
|
102
|
1951 {dict} is for functions with the "dict" attribute. It will be
|
|
1952 used to set the local variable "self". |Dictionary-function|
|
79
|
1953
|
777
|
1954 changenr() *changenr()*
|
|
1955 Return the number of the most recent change. This is the same
|
|
1956 number as what is displayed with |:undolist| and can be used
|
|
1957 with the |:undo| command.
|
|
1958 When a change was made it is the number of that change. After
|
|
1959 redo it is the number of the redone change. After undo it is
|
|
1960 one less than the number of the undone change.
|
|
1961
|
7
|
1962 char2nr({expr}) *char2nr()*
|
|
1963 Return number value of the first char in {expr}. Examples: >
|
|
1964 char2nr(" ") returns 32
|
|
1965 char2nr("ABC") returns 65
|
|
1966 < The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
|
653
|
1967 char2nr("?") returns 225
|
|
1968 char2nr("?"[0]) returns 195
|
236
|
1969 < nr2char() does the opposite.
|
7
|
1970
|
|
1971 cindent({lnum}) *cindent()*
|
|
1972 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the C
|
|
1973 indenting rules, as with 'cindent'.
|
|
1974 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
|
|
1975 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
|
|
1976 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the |+cindent|
|
|
1977 feature, -1 is returned.
|
548
|
1978 See |C-indenting|.
|
7
|
1979
|
|
1980 *col()*
|
24
|
1981 col({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the byte index of the column
|
7
|
1982 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
|
|
1983 . the cursor position
|
|
1984 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
|
|
1985 number of characters in the cursor line plus one)
|
|
1986 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
1987 returned)
|
703
|
1988 To get the line number use |col()|. To get both use
|
|
1989 |getpos()|.
|
7
|
1990 For the screen column position use |virtcol()|.
|
|
1991 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
|
|
1992 Examples: >
|
|
1993 col(".") column of cursor
|
|
1994 col("$") length of cursor line plus one
|
|
1995 col("'t") column of mark t
|
|
1996 col("'" . markname) column of mark markname
|
|
1997 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
|
|
1998 For the cursor position, when 'virtualedit' is active, the
|
|
1999 column is one higher if the cursor is after the end of the
|
|
2000 line. This can be used to obtain the column in Insert mode: >
|
|
2001 :imap <F2> <C-O>:let save_ve = &ve<CR>
|
|
2002 \<C-O>:set ve=all<CR>
|
|
2003 \<C-O>:echo col(".") . "\n" <Bar>
|
|
2004 \let &ve = save_ve<CR>
|
|
2005 <
|
464
|
2006
|
724
|
2007 complete({startcol}, {matches}) *complete()* *E785*
|
|
2008 Set the matches for Insert mode completion.
|
|
2009 Can only be used in Insert mode. You need to use a mapping
|
|
2010 with an expression argument |:map-<expr>| or CTRL-R =
|
|
2011 |i_CTRL-R|. It does not work after CTRL-O.
|
|
2012 {startcol} is the byte offset in the line where the completed
|
|
2013 text start. The text up to the cursor is the original text
|
|
2014 that will be replaced by the matches. Use col('.') for an
|
|
2015 empty string. "col('.') - 1" will replace one character by a
|
|
2016 match.
|
|
2017 {matches} must be a |List|. Each |List| item is one match.
|
|
2018 See |complete-items| for the kind of items that are possible.
|
|
2019 Note that the after calling this function you need to avoid
|
|
2020 inserting anything that would completion to stop.
|
|
2021 The match can be selected with CTRL-N and CTRL-P as usual with
|
|
2022 Insert mode completion. The popup menu will appear if
|
|
2023 specified, see |ins-completion-menu|.
|
|
2024 Example: >
|
|
2025 inoremap <expr> <F5> ListMonths()
|
|
2026
|
|
2027 func! ListMonths()
|
|
2028 call complete(col('.'), ['January', 'February', 'March',
|
|
2029 \ 'April', 'May', 'June', 'July', 'August', 'September',
|
|
2030 \ 'October', 'November', 'December'])
|
|
2031 return ''
|
|
2032 endfunc
|
|
2033 < This isn't very useful, but it shows how it works. Note that
|
|
2034 an empty string is returned to avoid a zero being inserted.
|
|
2035
|
464
|
2036 complete_add({expr}) *complete_add()*
|
|
2037 Add {expr} to the list of matches. Only to be used by the
|
|
2038 function specified with the 'completefunc' option.
|
|
2039 Returns 0 for failure (empty string or out of memory),
|
|
2040 1 when the match was added, 2 when the match was already in
|
|
2041 the list.
|
786
|
2042 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of {expr}. It is
|
|
2043 the same as one item in the list that 'omnifunc' would return.
|
464
|
2044
|
|
2045 complete_check() *complete_check()*
|
|
2046 Check for a key typed while looking for completion matches.
|
|
2047 This is to be used when looking for matches takes some time.
|
|
2048 Returns non-zero when searching for matches is to be aborted,
|
|
2049 zero otherwise.
|
|
2050 Only to be used by the function specified with the
|
|
2051 'completefunc' option.
|
|
2052
|
7
|
2053 *confirm()*
|
|
2054 confirm({msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
|
|
2055 Confirm() offers the user a dialog, from which a choice can be
|
|
2056 made. It returns the number of the choice. For the first
|
|
2057 choice this is 1.
|
|
2058 Note: confirm() is only supported when compiled with dialog
|
|
2059 support, see |+dialog_con| and |+dialog_gui|.
|
|
2060 {msg} is displayed in a |dialog| with {choices} as the
|
|
2061 alternatives. When {choices} is missing or empty, "&OK" is
|
|
2062 used (and translated).
|
|
2063 {msg} is a String, use '\n' to include a newline. Only on
|
|
2064 some systems the string is wrapped when it doesn't fit.
|
|
2065 {choices} is a String, with the individual choices separated
|
|
2066 by '\n', e.g. >
|
|
2067 confirm("Save changes?", "&Yes\n&No\n&Cancel")
|
|
2068 < The letter after the '&' is the shortcut key for that choice.
|
|
2069 Thus you can type 'c' to select "Cancel". The shortcut does
|
|
2070 not need to be the first letter: >
|
|
2071 confirm("file has been modified", "&Save\nSave &All")
|
|
2072 < For the console, the first letter of each choice is used as
|
|
2073 the default shortcut key.
|
|
2074 The optional {default} argument is the number of the choice
|
|
2075 that is made if the user hits <CR>. Use 1 to make the first
|
|
2076 choice the default one. Use 0 to not set a default. If
|
|
2077 {default} is omitted, 1 is used.
|
|
2078 The optional {type} argument gives the type of dialog. This
|
|
2079 is only used for the icon of the Win32 GUI. It can be one of
|
|
2080 these values: "Error", "Question", "Info", "Warning" or
|
|
2081 "Generic". Only the first character is relevant. When {type}
|
|
2082 is omitted, "Generic" is used.
|
|
2083 If the user aborts the dialog by pressing <Esc>, CTRL-C,
|
|
2084 or another valid interrupt key, confirm() returns 0.
|
|
2085
|
|
2086 An example: >
|
|
2087 :let choice = confirm("What do you want?", "&Apples\n&Oranges\n&Bananas", 2)
|
|
2088 :if choice == 0
|
|
2089 : echo "make up your mind!"
|
|
2090 :elseif choice == 3
|
|
2091 : echo "tasteful"
|
|
2092 :else
|
|
2093 : echo "I prefer bananas myself."
|
|
2094 :endif
|
|
2095 < In a GUI dialog, buttons are used. The layout of the buttons
|
|
2096 depends on the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. If it is included,
|
|
2097 the buttons are always put vertically. Otherwise, confirm()
|
|
2098 tries to put the buttons in one horizontal line. If they
|
|
2099 don't fit, a vertical layout is used anyway. For some systems
|
|
2100 the horizontal layout is always used.
|
|
2101
|
55
|
2102 *copy()*
|
|
2103 copy({expr}) Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
|
|
2104 different from using {expr} directly.
|
685
|
2105 When {expr} is a |List| a shallow copy is created. This means
|
|
2106 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
|
55
|
2107 copy, and vise versa. But the items are identical, thus
|
692
|
2108 changing an item changes the contents of both |Lists|. Also
|
685
|
2109 see |deepcopy()|.
|
55
|
2110
|
102
|
2111 count({comp}, {expr} [, {ic} [, {start}]]) *count()*
|
79
|
2112 Return the number of times an item with value {expr} appears
|
685
|
2113 in |List| or |Dictionary| {comp}.
|
102
|
2114 If {start} is given then start with the item with this index.
|
685
|
2115 {start} can only be used with a |List|.
|
79
|
2116 When {ic} is given and it's non-zero then case is ignored.
|
|
2117
|
|
2118
|
7
|
2119 *cscope_connection()*
|
|
2120 cscope_connection([{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
|
|
2121 Checks for the existence of a |cscope| connection. If no
|
|
2122 parameters are specified, then the function returns:
|
|
2123 0, if cscope was not available (not compiled in), or
|
|
2124 if there are no cscope connections;
|
|
2125 1, if there is at least one cscope connection.
|
|
2126
|
|
2127 If parameters are specified, then the value of {num}
|
|
2128 determines how existence of a cscope connection is checked:
|
|
2129
|
|
2130 {num} Description of existence check
|
|
2131 ----- ------------------------------
|
|
2132 0 Same as no parameters (e.g., "cscope_connection()").
|
|
2133 1 Ignore {prepend}, and use partial string matches for
|
|
2134 {dbpath}.
|
|
2135 2 Ignore {prepend}, and use exact string matches for
|
|
2136 {dbpath}.
|
|
2137 3 Use {prepend}, use partial string matches for both
|
|
2138 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
|
|
2139 4 Use {prepend}, use exact string matches for both
|
|
2140 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
|
|
2141
|
|
2142 Note: All string comparisons are case sensitive!
|
|
2143
|
|
2144 Examples. Suppose we had the following (from ":cs show"): >
|
|
2145
|
|
2146 # pid database name prepend path
|
|
2147 0 27664 cscope.out /usr/local
|
|
2148 <
|
|
2149 Invocation Return Val ~
|
|
2150 ---------- ---------- >
|
|
2151 cscope_connection() 1
|
|
2152 cscope_connection(1, "out") 1
|
|
2153 cscope_connection(2, "out") 0
|
|
2154 cscope_connection(3, "out") 0
|
|
2155 cscope_connection(3, "out", "local") 1
|
|
2156 cscope_connection(4, "out") 0
|
|
2157 cscope_connection(4, "out", "local") 0
|
|
2158 cscope_connection(4, "cscope.out", "/usr/local") 1
|
|
2159 <
|
703
|
2160 cursor({lnum}, {col} [, {off}]) *cursor()*
|
|
2161 cursor({list})
|
7
|
2162 Positions the cursor at the column {col} in the line {lnum}.
|
493
|
2163 The first column is one.
|
703
|
2164 When there is one argument {list} this is used as a |List|
|
707
|
2165 with two or three items {lnum}, {col} and {off}. This is like
|
|
2166 the return value of |getpos()|, but without the first item.
|
7
|
2167 Does not change the jumplist.
|
|
2168 If {lnum} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
|
|
2169 the cursor will be positioned at the last line in the buffer.
|
|
2170 If {lnum} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current line.
|
493
|
2171 If {col} is greater than the number of bytes in the line,
|
7
|
2172 the cursor will be positioned at the last character in the
|
|
2173 line.
|
|
2174 If {col} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current column.
|
703
|
2175 When 'virtualedit' is used {off} specifies the offset in
|
|
2176 screen columns from the start of the character. E.g., a
|
|
2177 position within a Tab or after the last character.
|
7
|
2178
|
55
|
2179
|
164
|
2180 deepcopy({expr}[, {noref}]) *deepcopy()* *E698*
|
55
|
2181 Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
|
|
2182 different from using {expr} directly.
|
685
|
2183 When {expr} is a |List| a full copy is created. This means
|
|
2184 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
|
|
2185 copy, and vise versa. When an item is a |List|, a copy for it
|
55
|
2186 is made, recursively. Thus changing an item in the copy does
|
685
|
2187 not change the contents of the original |List|.
|
|
2188 When {noref} is omitted or zero a contained |List| or
|
|
2189 |Dictionary| is only copied once. All references point to
|
|
2190 this single copy. With {noref} set to 1 every occurrence of a
|
|
2191 |List| or |Dictionary| results in a new copy. This also means
|
|
2192 that a cyclic reference causes deepcopy() to fail.
|
114
|
2193 *E724*
|
|
2194 Nesting is possible up to 100 levels. When there is an item
|
164
|
2195 that refers back to a higher level making a deep copy with
|
|
2196 {noref} set to 1 will fail.
|
55
|
2197 Also see |copy()|.
|
|
2198
|
|
2199 delete({fname}) *delete()*
|
|
2200 Deletes the file by the name {fname}. The result is a Number,
|
7
|
2201 which is 0 if the file was deleted successfully, and non-zero
|
|
2202 when the deletion failed.
|
685
|
2203 Use |remove()| to delete an item from a |List|.
|
7
|
2204
|
|
2205 *did_filetype()*
|
|
2206 did_filetype() Returns non-zero when autocommands are being executed and the
|
|
2207 FileType event has been triggered at least once. Can be used
|
|
2208 to avoid triggering the FileType event again in the scripts
|
|
2209 that detect the file type. |FileType|
|
|
2210 When editing another file, the counter is reset, thus this
|
|
2211 really checks if the FileType event has been triggered for the
|
|
2212 current buffer. This allows an autocommand that starts
|
|
2213 editing another buffer to set 'filetype' and load a syntax
|
|
2214 file.
|
|
2215
|
32
|
2216 diff_filler({lnum}) *diff_filler()*
|
|
2217 Returns the number of filler lines above line {lnum}.
|
|
2218 These are the lines that were inserted at this point in
|
|
2219 another diff'ed window. These filler lines are shown in the
|
|
2220 display but don't exist in the buffer.
|
|
2221 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2222 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2223 Returns 0 if the current window is not in diff mode.
|
|
2224
|
|
2225 diff_hlID({lnum}, {col}) *diff_hlID()*
|
|
2226 Returns the highlight ID for diff mode at line {lnum} column
|
|
2227 {col} (byte index). When the current line does not have a
|
|
2228 diff change zero is returned.
|
|
2229 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2230 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2231 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
|
|
2232 line.
|
|
2233 The highlight ID can be used with |synIDattr()| to obtain
|
|
2234 syntax information about the highlighting.
|
|
2235
|
85
|
2236 empty({expr}) *empty()*
|
|
2237 Return the Number 1 if {expr} is empty, zero otherwise.
|
685
|
2238 A |List| or |Dictionary| is empty when it does not have any
|
|
2239 items. A Number is empty when its value is zero.
|
|
2240 For a long |List| this is much faster then comparing the
|
|
2241 length with zero.
|
85
|
2242
|
7
|
2243 escape({string}, {chars}) *escape()*
|
|
2244 Escape the characters in {chars} that occur in {string} with a
|
|
2245 backslash. Example: >
|
|
2246 :echo escape('c:\program files\vim', ' \')
|
|
2247 < results in: >
|
|
2248 c:\\program\ files\\vim
|
95
|
2249
|
|
2250 < *eval()*
|
|
2251 eval({string}) Evaluate {string} and return the result. Especially useful to
|
|
2252 turn the result of |string()| back into the original value.
|
|
2253 This works for Numbers, Strings and composites of them.
|
685
|
2254 Also works for |Funcref|s that refer to existing functions.
|
95
|
2255
|
7
|
2256 eventhandler() *eventhandler()*
|
|
2257 Returns 1 when inside an event handler. That is that Vim got
|
|
2258 interrupted while waiting for the user to type a character,
|
|
2259 e.g., when dropping a file on Vim. This means interactive
|
|
2260 commands cannot be used. Otherwise zero is returned.
|
|
2261
|
|
2262 executable({expr}) *executable()*
|
|
2263 This function checks if an executable with the name {expr}
|
|
2264 exists. {expr} must be the name of the program without any
|
10
|
2265 arguments.
|
|
2266 executable() uses the value of $PATH and/or the normal
|
|
2267 searchpath for programs. *PATHEXT*
|
|
2268 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows the ".exe", ".bat", etc. can
|
|
2269 optionally be included. Then the extensions in $PATHEXT are
|
|
2270 tried. Thus if "foo.exe" does not exist, "foo.exe.bat" can be
|
|
2271 found. If $PATHEXT is not set then ".exe;.com;.bat;.cmd" is
|
|
2272 used. A dot by itself can be used in $PATHEXT to try using
|
|
2273 the name without an extension. When 'shell' looks like a
|
|
2274 Unix shell, then the name is also tried without adding an
|
|
2275 extension.
|
|
2276 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows it only checks if the file exists and
|
|
2277 is not a directory, not if it's really executable.
|
819
|
2278 On MS-Windows an executable in the same directory as Vim is
|
|
2279 always found. Since this directory is added to $PATH it
|
|
2280 should also work to execute it |win32-PATH|.
|
7
|
2281 The result is a Number:
|
|
2282 1 exists
|
|
2283 0 does not exist
|
|
2284 -1 not implemented on this system
|
|
2285
|
|
2286 *exists()*
|
|
2287 exists({expr}) The result is a Number, which is non-zero if {expr} is
|
|
2288 defined, zero otherwise. The {expr} argument is a string,
|
|
2289 which contains one of these:
|
|
2290 &option-name Vim option (only checks if it exists,
|
|
2291 not if it really works)
|
|
2292 +option-name Vim option that works.
|
|
2293 $ENVNAME environment variable (could also be
|
|
2294 done by comparing with an empty
|
|
2295 string)
|
|
2296 *funcname built-in function (see |functions|)
|
|
2297 or user defined function (see
|
|
2298 |user-functions|).
|
|
2299 varname internal variable (see
|
158
|
2300 |internal-variables|). Also works
|
685
|
2301 for |curly-braces-names|, |Dictionary|
|
|
2302 entries, |List| items, etc. Beware
|
|
2303 that this may cause functions to be
|
158
|
2304 invoked cause an error message for an
|
|
2305 invalid expression.
|
7
|
2306 :cmdname Ex command: built-in command, user
|
|
2307 command or command modifier |:command|.
|
|
2308 Returns:
|
|
2309 1 for match with start of a command
|
|
2310 2 full match with a command
|
|
2311 3 matches several user commands
|
|
2312 To check for a supported command
|
|
2313 always check the return value to be 2.
|
|
2314 #event autocommand defined for this event
|
|
2315 #event#pattern autocommand defined for this event and
|
|
2316 pattern (the pattern is taken
|
|
2317 literally and compared to the
|
|
2318 autocommand patterns character by
|
|
2319 character)
|
613
|
2320 #group autocommand group exists
|
|
2321 #group#event autocommand defined for this group and
|
|
2322 event.
|
|
2323 #group#event#pattern
|
|
2324 autocommand defined for this group,
|
|
2325 event and pattern.
|
615
|
2326 ##event autocommand for this event is
|
|
2327 supported.
|
7
|
2328 For checking for a supported feature use |has()|.
|
|
2329
|
|
2330 Examples: >
|
|
2331 exists("&shortname")
|
|
2332 exists("$HOSTNAME")
|
|
2333 exists("*strftime")
|
|
2334 exists("*s:MyFunc")
|
|
2335 exists("bufcount")
|
|
2336 exists(":Make")
|
613
|
2337 exists("#CursorHold")
|
7
|
2338 exists("#BufReadPre#*.gz")
|
613
|
2339 exists("#filetypeindent")
|
|
2340 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType")
|
|
2341 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType#*")
|
615
|
2342 exists("##ColorScheme")
|
7
|
2343 < There must be no space between the symbol (&/$/*/#) and the
|
|
2344 name.
|
|
2345 Note that the argument must be a string, not the name of the
|
|
2346 variable itself! For example: >
|
|
2347 exists(bufcount)
|
|
2348 < This doesn't check for existence of the "bufcount" variable,
|
|
2349 but gets the contents of "bufcount", and checks if that
|
|
2350 exists.
|
|
2351
|
|
2352 expand({expr} [, {flag}]) *expand()*
|
|
2353 Expand wildcards and the following special keywords in {expr}.
|
|
2354 The result is a String.
|
|
2355
|
|
2356 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
|
|
2357 characters. [Note: in version 5.0 a space was used, which
|
|
2358 caused problems when a file name contains a space]
|
|
2359
|
|
2360 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string. A name
|
|
2361 for a non-existing file is not included.
|
|
2362
|
|
2363 When {expr} starts with '%', '#' or '<', the expansion is done
|
|
2364 like for the |cmdline-special| variables with their associated
|
|
2365 modifiers. Here is a short overview:
|
|
2366
|
|
2367 % current file name
|
|
2368 # alternate file name
|
|
2369 #n alternate file name n
|
|
2370 <cfile> file name under the cursor
|
|
2371 <afile> autocmd file name
|
|
2372 <abuf> autocmd buffer number (as a String!)
|
|
2373 <amatch> autocmd matched name
|
|
2374 <sfile> sourced script file name
|
|
2375 <cword> word under the cursor
|
|
2376 <cWORD> WORD under the cursor
|
|
2377 <client> the {clientid} of the last received
|
|
2378 message |server2client()|
|
|
2379 Modifiers:
|
|
2380 :p expand to full path
|
|
2381 :h head (last path component removed)
|
|
2382 :t tail (last path component only)
|
|
2383 :r root (one extension removed)
|
|
2384 :e extension only
|
|
2385
|
|
2386 Example: >
|
|
2387 :let &tags = expand("%:p:h") . "/tags"
|
|
2388 < Note that when expanding a string that starts with '%', '#' or
|
|
2389 '<', any following text is ignored. This does NOT work: >
|
|
2390 :let doesntwork = expand("%:h.bak")
|
|
2391 < Use this: >
|
|
2392 :let doeswork = expand("%:h") . ".bak"
|
|
2393 < Also note that expanding "<cfile>" and others only returns the
|
|
2394 referenced file name without further expansion. If "<cfile>"
|
|
2395 is "~/.cshrc", you need to do another expand() to have the
|
|
2396 "~/" expanded into the path of the home directory: >
|
|
2397 :echo expand(expand("<cfile>"))
|
|
2398 <
|
|
2399 There cannot be white space between the variables and the
|
|
2400 following modifier. The |fnamemodify()| function can be used
|
|
2401 to modify normal file names.
|
|
2402
|
|
2403 When using '%' or '#', and the current or alternate file name
|
|
2404 is not defined, an empty string is used. Using "%:p" in a
|
|
2405 buffer with no name, results in the current directory, with a
|
|
2406 '/' added.
|
|
2407
|
|
2408 When {expr} does not start with '%', '#' or '<', it is
|
|
2409 expanded like a file name is expanded on the command line.
|
|
2410 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' are used, unless the optional
|
|
2411 {flag} argument is given and it is non-zero. Names for
|
444
|
2412 non-existing files are included. The "**" item can be used to
|
|
2413 search in a directory tree. For example, to find all "README"
|
|
2414 files in the current directory and below: >
|
|
2415 :echo expand("**/README")
|
|
2416 <
|
7
|
2417 Expand() can also be used to expand variables and environment
|
|
2418 variables that are only known in a shell. But this can be
|
|
2419 slow, because a shell must be started. See |expr-env-expand|.
|
|
2420 The expanded variable is still handled like a list of file
|
|
2421 names. When an environment variable cannot be expanded, it is
|
|
2422 left unchanged. Thus ":echo expand('$FOOBAR')" results in
|
|
2423 "$FOOBAR".
|
|
2424
|
|
2425 See |glob()| for finding existing files. See |system()| for
|
|
2426 getting the raw output of an external command.
|
|
2427
|
102
|
2428 extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}]) *extend()*
|
692
|
2429 {expr1} and {expr2} must be both |Lists| or both
|
|
2430 |Dictionaries|.
|
|
2431
|
|
2432 If they are |Lists|: Append {expr2} to {expr1}.
|
102
|
2433 If {expr3} is given insert the items of {expr2} before item
|
|
2434 {expr3} in {expr1}. When {expr3} is zero insert before the
|
|
2435 first item. When {expr3} is equal to len({expr1}) then
|
|
2436 {expr2} is appended.
|
79
|
2437 Examples: >
|
|
2438 :echo sort(extend(mylist, [7, 5]))
|
|
2439 :call extend(mylist, [2, 3], 1)
|
82
|
2440 < Use |add()| to concatenate one item to a list. To concatenate
|
|
2441 two lists into a new list use the + operator: >
|
79
|
2442 :let newlist = [1, 2, 3] + [4, 5]
|
102
|
2443 <
|
692
|
2444 If they are |Dictionaries|:
|
102
|
2445 Add all entries from {expr2} to {expr1}.
|
|
2446 If a key exists in both {expr1} and {expr2} then {expr3} is
|
|
2447 used to decide what to do:
|
|
2448 {expr3} = "keep": keep the value of {expr1}
|
|
2449 {expr3} = "force": use the value of {expr2}
|
119
|
2450 {expr3} = "error": give an error message *E737*
|
102
|
2451 When {expr3} is omitted then "force" is assumed.
|
|
2452
|
|
2453 {expr1} is changed when {expr2} is not empty. If necessary
|
|
2454 make a copy of {expr1} first.
|
|
2455 {expr2} remains unchanged.
|
|
2456 Returns {expr1}.
|
|
2457
|
79
|
2458
|
7
|
2459 filereadable({file}) *filereadable()*
|
|
2460 The result is a Number, which is TRUE when a file with the
|
|
2461 name {file} exists, and can be read. If {file} doesn't exist,
|
|
2462 or is a directory, the result is FALSE. {file} is any
|
|
2463 expression, which is used as a String.
|
|
2464 *file_readable()*
|
|
2465 Obsolete name: file_readable().
|
|
2466
|
95
|
2467
|
102
|
2468 filter({expr}, {string}) *filter()*
|
685
|
2469 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
2470 For each item in {expr} evaluate {string} and when the result
|
685
|
2471 is zero remove the item from the |List| or |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
2472 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
|
685
|
2473 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
|
102
|
2474 Examples: >
|
|
2475 :call filter(mylist, 'v:val !~ "OLD"')
|
|
2476 < Removes the items where "OLD" appears. >
|
|
2477 :call filter(mydict, 'v:key >= 8')
|
|
2478 < Removes the items with a key below 8. >
|
|
2479 :call filter(var, 0)
|
685
|
2480 < Removes all the items, thus clears the |List| or |Dictionary|.
|
99
|
2481
|
102
|
2482 Note that {string} is the result of expression and is then
|
|
2483 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
|
|
2484 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes.
|
|
2485
|
685
|
2486 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
|
|
2487 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
650
|
2488 :let l = filter(copy(mylist), 'v:val =~ "KEEP"')
|
102
|
2489
|
685
|
2490 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
|
648
|
2491 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
|
|
2492 further items in {expr} are processed.
|
95
|
2493
|
|
2494
|
19
|
2495 finddir({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *finddir()*
|
794
|
2496 Find directory {name} in {path}. Returns the path of the
|
|
2497 first found match. When the found directory is below the
|
|
2498 current directory a relative path is returned. Otherwise a
|
|
2499 full path is returned.
|
19
|
2500 If {path} is omitted or empty then 'path' is used.
|
|
2501 If the optional {count} is given, find {count}'s occurrence of
|
794
|
2502 {name} in {path} instead of the first one.
|
809
|
2503 When {count} is negative return all the matches in a |List|.
|
19
|
2504 This is quite similar to the ex-command |:find|.
|
794
|
2505 {only available when compiled with the +file_in_path feature}
|
|
2506
|
|
2507 findfile({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *findfile()*
|
|
2508 Just like |finddir()|, but find a file instead of a directory.
|
|
2509 Uses 'suffixesadd'.
|
19
|
2510 Example: >
|
|
2511 :echo findfile("tags.vim", ".;")
|
|
2512 < Searches from the current directory upwards until it finds
|
|
2513 the file "tags.vim".
|
|
2514
|
7
|
2515 filewritable({file}) *filewritable()*
|
|
2516 The result is a Number, which is 1 when a file with the
|
|
2517 name {file} exists, and can be written. If {file} doesn't
|
|
2518 exist, or is not writable, the result is 0. If (file) is a
|
|
2519 directory, and we can write to it, the result is 2.
|
|
2520
|
|
2521 fnamemodify({fname}, {mods}) *fnamemodify()*
|
|
2522 Modify file name {fname} according to {mods}. {mods} is a
|
|
2523 string of characters like it is used for file names on the
|
|
2524 command line. See |filename-modifiers|.
|
|
2525 Example: >
|
|
2526 :echo fnamemodify("main.c", ":p:h")
|
|
2527 < results in: >
|
|
2528 /home/mool/vim/vim/src
|
|
2529 < Note: Environment variables and "~" don't work in {fname}, use
|
|
2530 |expand()| first then.
|
|
2531
|
|
2532 foldclosed({lnum}) *foldclosed()*
|
|
2533 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
|
|
2534 fold, the result is the number of the first line in that fold.
|
|
2535 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
|
|
2536
|
|
2537 foldclosedend({lnum}) *foldclosedend()*
|
|
2538 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
|
|
2539 fold, the result is the number of the last line in that fold.
|
|
2540 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
|
|
2541
|
|
2542 foldlevel({lnum}) *foldlevel()*
|
|
2543 The result is a Number, which is the foldlevel of line {lnum}
|
|
2544 in the current buffer. For nested folds the deepest level is
|
|
2545 returned. If there is no fold at line {lnum}, zero is
|
|
2546 returned. It doesn't matter if the folds are open or closed.
|
|
2547 When used while updating folds (from 'foldexpr') -1 is
|
|
2548 returned for lines where folds are still to be updated and the
|
|
2549 foldlevel is unknown. As a special case the level of the
|
|
2550 previous line is usually available.
|
|
2551
|
|
2552 *foldtext()*
|
|
2553 foldtext() Returns a String, to be displayed for a closed fold. This is
|
|
2554 the default function used for the 'foldtext' option and should
|
|
2555 only be called from evaluating 'foldtext'. It uses the
|
|
2556 |v:foldstart|, |v:foldend| and |v:folddashes| variables.
|
|
2557 The returned string looks like this: >
|
|
2558 +-- 45 lines: abcdef
|
|
2559 < The number of dashes depends on the foldlevel. The "45" is
|
|
2560 the number of lines in the fold. "abcdef" is the text in the
|
|
2561 first non-blank line of the fold. Leading white space, "//"
|
|
2562 or "/*" and the text from the 'foldmarker' and 'commentstring'
|
|
2563 options is removed.
|
|
2564 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
|
|
2565
|
29
|
2566 foldtextresult({lnum}) *foldtextresult()*
|
|
2567 Returns the text that is displayed for the closed fold at line
|
|
2568 {lnum}. Evaluates 'foldtext' in the appropriate context.
|
|
2569 When there is no closed fold at {lnum} an empty string is
|
|
2570 returned.
|
|
2571 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2572 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2573 Useful when exporting folded text, e.g., to HTML.
|
|
2574 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
|
|
2575
|
7
|
2576 *foreground()*
|
|
2577 foreground() Move the Vim window to the foreground. Useful when sent from
|
|
2578 a client to a Vim server. |remote_send()|
|
|
2579 On Win32 systems this might not work, the OS does not always
|
|
2580 allow a window to bring itself to the foreground. Use
|
|
2581 |remote_foreground()| instead.
|
|
2582 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
|
|
2583 Win32 console version}
|
|
2584
|
82
|
2585
|
85
|
2586 function({name}) *function()* *E700*
|
685
|
2587 Return a |Funcref| variable that refers to function {name}.
|
55
|
2588 {name} can be a user defined function or an internal function.
|
|
2589
|
82
|
2590
|
370
|
2591 garbagecollect() *garbagecollect()*
|
692
|
2592 Cleanup unused |Lists| and |Dictionaries| that have circular
|
370
|
2593 references. There is hardly ever a need to invoke this
|
|
2594 function, as it is automatically done when Vim runs out of
|
|
2595 memory or is waiting for the user to press a key after
|
|
2596 'updatetime'. Items without circular references are always
|
|
2597 freed when they become unused.
|
685
|
2598 This is useful if you have deleted a very big |List| and/or
|
|
2599 |Dictionary| with circular references in a script that runs
|
|
2600 for a long time.
|
370
|
2601
|
140
|
2602 get({list}, {idx} [, {default}]) *get()*
|
685
|
2603 Get item {idx} from |List| {list}. When this item is not
|
82
|
2604 available return {default}. Return zero when {default} is
|
|
2605 omitted.
|
102
|
2606 get({dict}, {key} [, {default}])
|
685
|
2607 Get item with key {key} from |Dictionary| {dict}. When this
|
102
|
2608 item is not available return {default}. Return zero when
|
|
2609 {default} is omitted.
|
|
2610
|
435
|
2611 *getbufline()*
|
|
2612 getbufline({expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
|
685
|
2613 Return a |List| with the lines starting from {lnum} to {end}
|
|
2614 (inclusive) in the buffer {expr}. If {end} is omitted, a
|
|
2615 |List| with only the line {lnum} is returned.
|
435
|
2616
|
|
2617 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
2618
|
448
|
2619 For {lnum} and {end} "$" can be used for the last line of the
|
|
2620 buffer. Otherwise a number must be used.
|
435
|
2621
|
|
2622 When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
|
685
|
2623 lines in the buffer, an empty |List| is returned.
|
435
|
2624
|
|
2625 When {end} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
|
|
2626 it is treated as {end} is set to the number of lines in the
|
685
|
2627 buffer. When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is
|
435
|
2628 returned.
|
|
2629
|
448
|
2630 This function works only for loaded buffers. For unloaded and
|
685
|
2631 non-existing buffers, an empty |List| is returned.
|
435
|
2632
|
|
2633 Example: >
|
|
2634 :let lines = getbufline(bufnr("myfile"), 1, "$")
|
82
|
2635
|
|
2636 getbufvar({expr}, {varname}) *getbufvar()*
|
|
2637 The result is the value of option or local buffer variable
|
|
2638 {varname} in buffer {expr}. Note that the name without "b:"
|
|
2639 must be used.
|
216
|
2640 This also works for a global or buffer-local option, but it
|
|
2641 doesn't work for a global variable, window-local variable or
|
|
2642 window-local option.
|
82
|
2643 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
2644 When the buffer or variable doesn't exist an empty string is
|
|
2645 returned, there is no error message.
|
|
2646 Examples: >
|
|
2647 :let bufmodified = getbufvar(1, "&mod")
|
|
2648 :echo "todo myvar = " . getbufvar("todo", "myvar")
|
|
2649 <
|
7
|
2650 getchar([expr]) *getchar()*
|
|
2651 Get a single character from the user. If it is an 8-bit
|
|
2652 character, the result is a number. Otherwise a String is
|
|
2653 returned with the encoded character. For a special key it's a
|
|
2654 sequence of bytes starting with 0x80 (decimal: 128).
|
|
2655 If [expr] is omitted, wait until a character is available.
|
|
2656 If [expr] is 0, only get a character when one is available.
|
|
2657 If [expr] is 1, only check if a character is available, it is
|
|
2658 not consumed. If a normal character is
|
|
2659 available, it is returned, otherwise a
|
|
2660 non-zero value is returned.
|
|
2661 If a normal character available, it is returned as a Number.
|
|
2662 Use nr2char() to convert it to a String.
|
|
2663 The returned value is zero if no character is available.
|
|
2664 The returned value is a string of characters for special keys
|
|
2665 and when a modifier (shift, control, alt) was used.
|
|
2666 There is no prompt, you will somehow have to make clear to the
|
|
2667 user that a character has to be typed.
|
|
2668 There is no mapping for the character.
|
|
2669 Key codes are replaced, thus when the user presses the <Del>
|
|
2670 key you get the code for the <Del> key, not the raw character
|
|
2671 sequence. Examples: >
|
|
2672 getchar() == "\<Del>"
|
|
2673 getchar() == "\<S-Left>"
|
|
2674 < This example redefines "f" to ignore case: >
|
|
2675 :nmap f :call FindChar()<CR>
|
|
2676 :function FindChar()
|
|
2677 : let c = nr2char(getchar())
|
|
2678 : while col('.') < col('$') - 1
|
|
2679 : normal l
|
|
2680 : if getline('.')[col('.') - 1] ==? c
|
|
2681 : break
|
|
2682 : endif
|
|
2683 : endwhile
|
|
2684 :endfunction
|
|
2685
|
|
2686 getcharmod() *getcharmod()*
|
|
2687 The result is a Number which is the state of the modifiers for
|
|
2688 the last obtained character with getchar() or in another way.
|
|
2689 These values are added together:
|
|
2690 2 shift
|
|
2691 4 control
|
|
2692 8 alt (meta)
|
|
2693 16 mouse double click
|
|
2694 32 mouse triple click
|
|
2695 64 mouse quadruple click
|
|
2696 128 Macintosh only: command
|
|
2697 Only the modifiers that have not been included in the
|
|
2698 character itself are obtained. Thus Shift-a results in "A"
|
|
2699 with no modifier.
|
|
2700
|
|
2701 getcmdline() *getcmdline()*
|
|
2702 Return the current command-line. Only works when the command
|
|
2703 line is being edited, thus requires use of |c_CTRL-\_e| or
|
|
2704 |c_CTRL-R_=|.
|
|
2705 Example: >
|
|
2706 :cmap <F7> <C-\>eescape(getcmdline(), ' \')<CR>
|
531
|
2707 < Also see |getcmdtype()|, |getcmdpos()| and |setcmdpos()|.
|
7
|
2708
|
95
|
2709 getcmdpos() *getcmdpos()*
|
7
|
2710 Return the position of the cursor in the command line as a
|
|
2711 byte count. The first column is 1.
|
|
2712 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
|
|
2713 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns 0 otherwise.
|
531
|
2714 Also see |getcmdtype()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
|
|
2715
|
|
2716 getcmdtype() *getcmdtype()*
|
|
2717 Return the current command-line type. Possible return values
|
|
2718 are:
|
532
|
2719 : normal Ex command
|
|
2720 > debug mode command |debug-mode|
|
|
2721 / forward search command
|
|
2722 ? backward search command
|
|
2723 @ |input()| command
|
|
2724 - |:insert| or |:append| command
|
531
|
2725 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
|
|
2726 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns an empty string
|
|
2727 otherwise.
|
|
2728 Also see |getcmdpos()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
|
7
|
2729
|
|
2730 *getcwd()*
|
|
2731 getcwd() The result is a String, which is the name of the current
|
|
2732 working directory.
|
|
2733
|
|
2734 getfsize({fname}) *getfsize()*
|
|
2735 The result is a Number, which is the size in bytes of the
|
|
2736 given file {fname}.
|
|
2737 If {fname} is a directory, 0 is returned.
|
|
2738 If the file {fname} can't be found, -1 is returned.
|
|
2739
|
37
|
2740 getfontname([{name}]) *getfontname()*
|
|
2741 Without an argument returns the name of the normal font being
|
|
2742 used. Like what is used for the Normal highlight group
|
|
2743 |hl-Normal|.
|
|
2744 With an argument a check is done whether {name} is a valid
|
|
2745 font name. If not then an empty string is returned.
|
|
2746 Otherwise the actual font name is returned, or {name} if the
|
|
2747 GUI does not support obtaining the real name.
|
824
|
2748 Only works when the GUI is running, thus not in your vimrc or
|
819
|
2749 gvimrc file. Use the |GUIEnter| autocommand to use this
|
|
2750 function just after the GUI has started.
|
37
|
2751 Note that the GTK 2 GUI accepts any font name, thus checking
|
|
2752 for a valid name does not work.
|
|
2753
|
20
|
2754 getfperm({fname}) *getfperm()*
|
|
2755 The result is a String, which is the read, write, and execute
|
|
2756 permissions of the given file {fname}.
|
|
2757 If {fname} does not exist or its directory cannot be read, an
|
|
2758 empty string is returned.
|
|
2759 The result is of the form "rwxrwxrwx", where each group of
|
|
2760 "rwx" flags represent, in turn, the permissions of the owner
|
|
2761 of the file, the group the file belongs to, and other users.
|
|
2762 If a user does not have a given permission the flag for this
|
|
2763 is replaced with the string "-". Example: >
|
|
2764 :echo getfperm("/etc/passwd")
|
|
2765 < This will hopefully (from a security point of view) display
|
|
2766 the string "rw-r--r--" or even "rw-------".
|
205
|
2767
|
7
|
2768 getftime({fname}) *getftime()*
|
|
2769 The result is a Number, which is the last modification time of
|
|
2770 the given file {fname}. The value is measured as seconds
|
|
2771 since 1st Jan 1970, and may be passed to strftime(). See also
|
|
2772 |localtime()| and |strftime()|.
|
|
2773 If the file {fname} can't be found -1 is returned.
|
|
2774
|
20
|
2775 getftype({fname}) *getftype()*
|
|
2776 The result is a String, which is a description of the kind of
|
|
2777 file of the given file {fname}.
|
|
2778 If {fname} does not exist an empty string is returned.
|
|
2779 Here is a table over different kinds of files and their
|
|
2780 results:
|
|
2781 Normal file "file"
|
|
2782 Directory "dir"
|
|
2783 Symbolic link "link"
|
|
2784 Block device "bdev"
|
|
2785 Character device "cdev"
|
|
2786 Socket "socket"
|
|
2787 FIFO "fifo"
|
|
2788 All other "other"
|
|
2789 Example: >
|
|
2790 getftype("/home")
|
|
2791 < Note that a type such as "link" will only be returned on
|
|
2792 systems that support it. On some systems only "dir" and
|
|
2793 "file" are returned.
|
|
2794
|
7
|
2795 *getline()*
|
82
|
2796 getline({lnum} [, {end}])
|
|
2797 Without {end} the result is a String, which is line {lnum}
|
|
2798 from the current buffer. Example: >
|
7
|
2799 getline(1)
|
|
2800 < When {lnum} is a String that doesn't start with a
|
|
2801 digit, line() is called to translate the String into a Number.
|
|
2802 To get the line under the cursor: >
|
|
2803 getline(".")
|
|
2804 < When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
|
|
2805 lines in the buffer, an empty string is returned.
|
|
2806
|
685
|
2807 When {end} is given the result is a |List| where each item is
|
|
2808 a line from the current buffer in the range {lnum} to {end},
|
82
|
2809 including line {end}.
|
|
2810 {end} is used in the same way as {lnum}.
|
|
2811 Non-existing lines are silently omitted.
|
685
|
2812 When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is returned.
|
82
|
2813 Example: >
|
|
2814 :let start = line('.')
|
|
2815 :let end = search("^$") - 1
|
|
2816 :let lines = getline(start, end)
|
|
2817
|
647
|
2818 getloclist({nr}) *getloclist()*
|
|
2819 Returns a list with all the entries in the location list for
|
|
2820 window {nr}. When {nr} is zero the current window is used.
|
|
2821 For a location list window, the displayed location list is
|
648
|
2822 returned. For an invalid window number {nr}, an empty list is
|
|
2823 returned. Otherwise, same as getqflist().
|
82
|
2824
|
230
|
2825 getqflist() *getqflist()*
|
|
2826 Returns a list with all the current quickfix errors. Each
|
|
2827 list item is a dictionary with these entries:
|
|
2828 bufnr number of buffer that has the file name, use
|
|
2829 bufname() to get the name
|
|
2830 lnum line number in the buffer (first line is 1)
|
|
2831 col column number (first column is 1)
|
233
|
2832 vcol non-zero: "col" is visual column
|
|
2833 zero: "col" is byte index
|
230
|
2834 nr error number
|
|
2835 text description of the error
|
|
2836 type type of the error, 'E', '1', etc.
|
|
2837 valid non-zero: recognized error message
|
|
2838
|
515
|
2839 When there is no error list or it's empty an empty list is
|
|
2840 returned.
|
|
2841
|
230
|
2842 Useful application: Find pattern matches in multiple files and
|
|
2843 do something with them: >
|
|
2844 :vimgrep /theword/jg *.c
|
|
2845 :for d in getqflist()
|
|
2846 : echo bufname(d.bufnr) ':' d.lnum '=' d.text
|
|
2847 :endfor
|
|
2848
|
|
2849
|
282
|
2850 getreg([{regname} [, 1]]) *getreg()*
|
7
|
2851 The result is a String, which is the contents of register
|
236
|
2852 {regname}. Example: >
|
7
|
2853 :let cliptext = getreg('*')
|
|
2854 < getreg('=') returns the last evaluated value of the expression
|
236
|
2855 register. (For use in maps.)
|
282
|
2856 getreg('=', 1) returns the expression itself, so that it can
|
|
2857 be restored with |setreg()|. For other registers the extra
|
|
2858 argument is ignored, thus you can always give it.
|
7
|
2859 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
|
|
2860
|
82
|
2861
|
7
|
2862 getregtype([{regname}]) *getregtype()*
|
|
2863 The result is a String, which is type of register {regname}.
|
|
2864 The value will be one of:
|
|
2865 "v" for |characterwise| text
|
|
2866 "V" for |linewise| text
|
|
2867 "<CTRL-V>{width}" for |blockwise-visual| text
|
|
2868 0 for an empty or unknown register
|
|
2869 <CTRL-V> is one character with value 0x16.
|
|
2870 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
|
|
2871
|
831
|
2872 gettabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}) *gettabwinvar()*
|
|
2873 Get the value of an option or local window variable {varname}
|
|
2874 in window {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}.
|
|
2875 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
|
|
2876 use |getwinvar()|.
|
|
2877 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
|
|
2878 This also works for a global option, buffer-local option and
|
|
2879 window-local option, but it doesn't work for a global variable
|
|
2880 or buffer-local variable.
|
|
2881 Note that the name without "w:" must be used.
|
|
2882 Examples: >
|
|
2883 :let list_is_on = gettabwinvar(1, 2, '&list')
|
|
2884 :echo "myvar = " . gettabwinvar(3, 1, 'myvar')
|
|
2885
|
7
|
2886 *getwinposx()*
|
|
2887 getwinposx() The result is a Number, which is the X coordinate in pixels of
|
|
2888 the left hand side of the GUI Vim window. The result will be
|
|
2889 -1 if the information is not available.
|
|
2890
|
|
2891 *getwinposy()*
|
|
2892 getwinposy() The result is a Number, which is the Y coordinate in pixels of
|
|
2893 the top of the GUI Vim window. The result will be -1 if the
|
|
2894 information is not available.
|
|
2895
|
831
|
2896 getwinvar({winnr}, {varname}) *getwinvar()*
|
|
2897 Like |gettabwinvar()| for the current tabpage.
|
7
|
2898 Examples: >
|
|
2899 :let list_is_on = getwinvar(2, '&list')
|
|
2900 :echo "myvar = " . getwinvar(1, 'myvar')
|
|
2901 <
|
|
2902 *glob()*
|
|
2903 glob({expr}) Expand the file wildcards in {expr}. The result is a String.
|
|
2904 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
|
|
2905 characters.
|
|
2906 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string.
|
|
2907 A name for a non-existing file is not included.
|
|
2908
|
|
2909 For most systems backticks can be used to get files names from
|
|
2910 any external command. Example: >
|
|
2911 :let tagfiles = glob("`find . -name tags -print`")
|
|
2912 :let &tags = substitute(tagfiles, "\n", ",", "g")
|
|
2913 < The result of the program inside the backticks should be one
|
|
2914 item per line. Spaces inside an item are allowed.
|
|
2915
|
|
2916 See |expand()| for expanding special Vim variables. See
|
|
2917 |system()| for getting the raw output of an external command.
|
|
2918
|
|
2919 globpath({path}, {expr}) *globpath()*
|
|
2920 Perform glob() on all directories in {path} and concatenate
|
|
2921 the results. Example: >
|
|
2922 :echo globpath(&rtp, "syntax/c.vim")
|
|
2923 < {path} is a comma-separated list of directory names. Each
|
|
2924 directory name is prepended to {expr} and expanded like with
|
|
2925 glob(). A path separator is inserted when needed.
|
|
2926 To add a comma inside a directory name escape it with a
|
|
2927 backslash. Note that on MS-Windows a directory may have a
|
|
2928 trailing backslash, remove it if you put a comma after it.
|
|
2929 If the expansion fails for one of the directories, there is no
|
|
2930 error message.
|
|
2931 The 'wildignore' option applies: Names matching one of the
|
|
2932 patterns in 'wildignore' will be skipped.
|
|
2933
|
444
|
2934 The "**" item can be used to search in a directory tree.
|
|
2935 For example, to find all "README.txt" files in the directories
|
|
2936 in 'runtimepath' and below: >
|
|
2937 :echo globpath(&rtp, "**/README.txt")
|
|
2938 <
|
7
|
2939 *has()*
|
|
2940 has({feature}) The result is a Number, which is 1 if the feature {feature} is
|
|
2941 supported, zero otherwise. The {feature} argument is a
|
|
2942 string. See |feature-list| below.
|
|
2943 Also see |exists()|.
|
|
2944
|
102
|
2945
|
|
2946 has_key({dict}, {key}) *has_key()*
|
685
|
2947 The result is a Number, which is 1 if |Dictionary| {dict} has
|
|
2948 an entry with key {key}. Zero otherwise.
|
102
|
2949
|
|
2950
|
782
|
2951 hasmapto({what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *hasmapto()*
|
7
|
2952 The result is a Number, which is 1 if there is a mapping that
|
|
2953 contains {what} in somewhere in the rhs (what it is mapped to)
|
|
2954 and this mapping exists in one of the modes indicated by
|
|
2955 {mode}.
|
782
|
2956 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
786
|
2957 instead of mappings. Don't forget to specify Insert and/or
|
|
2958 Command-line mode.
|
7
|
2959 Both the global mappings and the mappings local to the current
|
|
2960 buffer are checked for a match.
|
|
2961 If no matching mapping is found 0 is returned.
|
|
2962 The following characters are recognized in {mode}:
|
|
2963 n Normal mode
|
|
2964 v Visual mode
|
|
2965 o Operator-pending mode
|
|
2966 i Insert mode
|
|
2967 l Language-Argument ("r", "f", "t", etc.)
|
|
2968 c Command-line mode
|
|
2969 When {mode} is omitted, "nvo" is used.
|
|
2970
|
|
2971 This function is useful to check if a mapping already exists
|
|
2972 to a function in a Vim script. Example: >
|
|
2973 :if !hasmapto('\ABCdoit')
|
|
2974 : map <Leader>d \ABCdoit
|
|
2975 :endif
|
|
2976 < This installs the mapping to "\ABCdoit" only if there isn't
|
|
2977 already a mapping to "\ABCdoit".
|
|
2978
|
|
2979 histadd({history}, {item}) *histadd()*
|
|
2980 Add the String {item} to the history {history} which can be
|
|
2981 one of: *hist-names*
|
|
2982 "cmd" or ":" command line history
|
|
2983 "search" or "/" search pattern history
|
|
2984 "expr" or "=" typed expression history
|
|
2985 "input" or "@" input line history
|
|
2986 If {item} does already exist in the history, it will be
|
|
2987 shifted to become the newest entry.
|
|
2988 The result is a Number: 1 if the operation was successful,
|
|
2989 otherwise 0 is returned.
|
|
2990
|
|
2991 Example: >
|
|
2992 :call histadd("input", strftime("%Y %b %d"))
|
|
2993 :let date=input("Enter date: ")
|
|
2994 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
2995
|
|
2996 histdel({history} [, {item}]) *histdel()*
|
236
|
2997 Clear {history}, i.e. delete all its entries. See |hist-names|
|
7
|
2998 for the possible values of {history}.
|
|
2999
|
|
3000 If the parameter {item} is given as String, this is seen
|
|
3001 as regular expression. All entries matching that expression
|
|
3002 will be removed from the history (if there are any).
|
|
3003 Upper/lowercase must match, unless "\c" is used |/\c|.
|
|
3004 If {item} is a Number, it will be interpreted as index, see
|
|
3005 |:history-indexing|. The respective entry will be removed
|
|
3006 if it exists.
|
|
3007
|
|
3008 The result is a Number: 1 for a successful operation,
|
|
3009 otherwise 0 is returned.
|
|
3010
|
|
3011 Examples:
|
|
3012 Clear expression register history: >
|
|
3013 :call histdel("expr")
|
|
3014 <
|
|
3015 Remove all entries starting with "*" from the search history: >
|
|
3016 :call histdel("/", '^\*')
|
|
3017 <
|
|
3018 The following three are equivalent: >
|
|
3019 :call histdel("search", histnr("search"))
|
|
3020 :call histdel("search", -1)
|
|
3021 :call histdel("search", '^'.histget("search", -1).'$')
|
|
3022 <
|
|
3023 To delete the last search pattern and use the last-but-one for
|
|
3024 the "n" command and 'hlsearch': >
|
|
3025 :call histdel("search", -1)
|
|
3026 :let @/ = histget("search", -1)
|
|
3027
|
|
3028 histget({history} [, {index}]) *histget()*
|
|
3029 The result is a String, the entry with Number {index} from
|
|
3030 {history}. See |hist-names| for the possible values of
|
|
3031 {history}, and |:history-indexing| for {index}. If there is
|
|
3032 no such entry, an empty String is returned. When {index} is
|
|
3033 omitted, the most recent item from the history is used.
|
|
3034
|
|
3035 Examples:
|
|
3036 Redo the second last search from history. >
|
|
3037 :execute '/' . histget("search", -2)
|
|
3038
|
|
3039 < Define an Ex command ":H {num}" that supports re-execution of
|
|
3040 the {num}th entry from the output of |:history|. >
|
|
3041 :command -nargs=1 H execute histget("cmd", 0+<args>)
|
|
3042 <
|
|
3043 histnr({history}) *histnr()*
|
|
3044 The result is the Number of the current entry in {history}.
|
|
3045 See |hist-names| for the possible values of {history}.
|
|
3046 If an error occurred, -1 is returned.
|
|
3047
|
|
3048 Example: >
|
|
3049 :let inp_index = histnr("expr")
|
|
3050 <
|
|
3051 hlexists({name}) *hlexists()*
|
|
3052 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a highlight group
|
|
3053 called {name} exists. This is when the group has been
|
|
3054 defined in some way. Not necessarily when highlighting has
|
|
3055 been defined for it, it may also have been used for a syntax
|
|
3056 item.
|
|
3057 *highlight_exists()*
|
|
3058 Obsolete name: highlight_exists().
|
|
3059
|
|
3060 *hlID()*
|
|
3061 hlID({name}) The result is a Number, which is the ID of the highlight group
|
|
3062 with name {name}. When the highlight group doesn't exist,
|
|
3063 zero is returned.
|
|
3064 This can be used to retrieve information about the highlight
|
|
3065 group. For example, to get the background color of the
|
|
3066 "Comment" group: >
|
|
3067 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(hlID("Comment")), "bg")
|
|
3068 < *highlightID()*
|
|
3069 Obsolete name: highlightID().
|
|
3070
|
|
3071 hostname() *hostname()*
|
|
3072 The result is a String, which is the name of the machine on
|
236
|
3073 which Vim is currently running. Machine names greater than
|
7
|
3074 256 characters long are truncated.
|
|
3075
|
|
3076 iconv({expr}, {from}, {to}) *iconv()*
|
|
3077 The result is a String, which is the text {expr} converted
|
|
3078 from encoding {from} to encoding {to}.
|
|
3079 When the conversion fails an empty string is returned.
|
|
3080 The encoding names are whatever the iconv() library function
|
|
3081 can accept, see ":!man 3 iconv".
|
|
3082 Most conversions require Vim to be compiled with the |+iconv|
|
|
3083 feature. Otherwise only UTF-8 to latin1 conversion and back
|
|
3084 can be done.
|
|
3085 This can be used to display messages with special characters,
|
|
3086 no matter what 'encoding' is set to. Write the message in
|
|
3087 UTF-8 and use: >
|
|
3088 echo iconv(utf8_str, "utf-8", &enc)
|
|
3089 < Note that Vim uses UTF-8 for all Unicode encodings, conversion
|
|
3090 from/to UCS-2 is automatically changed to use UTF-8. You
|
|
3091 cannot use UCS-2 in a string anyway, because of the NUL bytes.
|
|
3092 {only available when compiled with the +multi_byte feature}
|
|
3093
|
|
3094 *indent()*
|
|
3095 indent({lnum}) The result is a Number, which is indent of line {lnum} in the
|
|
3096 current buffer. The indent is counted in spaces, the value
|
|
3097 of 'tabstop' is relevant. {lnum} is used just like in
|
|
3098 |getline()|.
|
|
3099 When {lnum} is invalid -1 is returned.
|
|
3100
|
79
|
3101
|
95
|
3102 index({list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]]) *index()*
|
685
|
3103 Return the lowest index in |List| {list} where the item has a
|
79
|
3104 value equal to {expr}.
|
153
|
3105 If {start} is given then start looking at the item with index
|
|
3106 {start} (may be negative for an item relative to the end).
|
79
|
3107 When {ic} is given and it is non-zero, ignore case. Otherwise
|
|
3108 case must match.
|
|
3109 -1 is returned when {expr} is not found in {list}.
|
|
3110 Example: >
|
|
3111 :let idx = index(words, "the")
|
87
|
3112 :if index(numbers, 123) >= 0
|
79
|
3113
|
|
3114
|
531
|
3115 input({prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]]) *input()*
|
7
|
3116 The result is a String, which is whatever the user typed on
|
|
3117 the command-line. The parameter is either a prompt string, or
|
|
3118 a blank string (for no prompt). A '\n' can be used in the
|
531
|
3119 prompt to start a new line.
|
|
3120 The highlighting set with |:echohl| is used for the prompt.
|
|
3121 The input is entered just like a command-line, with the same
|
|
3122 editing commands and mappings. There is a separate history
|
|
3123 for lines typed for input().
|
|
3124 Example: >
|
|
3125 :if input("Coffee or beer? ") == "beer"
|
|
3126 : echo "Cheers!"
|
|
3127 :endif
|
|
3128 <
|
532
|
3129 If the optional {text} is present and not empty, this is used
|
|
3130 for the default reply, as if the user typed this. Example: >
|
531
|
3131 :let color = input("Color? ", "white")
|
|
3132
|
|
3133 < The optional {completion} argument specifies the type of
|
|
3134 completion supported for the input. Without it completion is
|
|
3135 not performed. The supported completion types are the same as
|
|
3136 that can be supplied to a user-defined command using the
|
|
3137 "-complete=" argument. Refer to |:command-completion| for
|
|
3138 more information. Example: >
|
|
3139 let fname = input("File: ", "", "file")
|
|
3140 <
|
|
3141 NOTE: This function must not be used in a startup file, for
|
|
3142 the versions that only run in GUI mode (e.g., the Win32 GUI).
|
7
|
3143 Note: When input() is called from within a mapping it will
|
|
3144 consume remaining characters from that mapping, because a
|
|
3145 mapping is handled like the characters were typed.
|
|
3146 Use |inputsave()| before input() and |inputrestore()|
|
|
3147 after input() to avoid that. Another solution is to avoid
|
|
3148 that further characters follow in the mapping, e.g., by using
|
|
3149 |:execute| or |:normal|.
|
|
3150
|
531
|
3151 Example with a mapping: >
|
7
|
3152 :nmap \x :call GetFoo()<CR>:exe "/" . Foo<CR>
|
|
3153 :function GetFoo()
|
|
3154 : call inputsave()
|
|
3155 : let g:Foo = input("enter search pattern: ")
|
|
3156 : call inputrestore()
|
|
3157 :endfunction
|
|
3158
|
|
3159 inputdialog({prompt} [, {text} [, {cancelreturn}]]) *inputdialog()*
|
|
3160 Like input(), but when the GUI is running and text dialogs are
|
|
3161 supported, a dialog window pops up to input the text.
|
|
3162 Example: >
|
|
3163 :let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", &sw)
|
|
3164 :if n != ""
|
|
3165 : let &sw = n
|
|
3166 :endif
|
|
3167 < When the dialog is cancelled {cancelreturn} is returned. When
|
|
3168 omitted an empty string is returned.
|
|
3169 Hitting <Enter> works like pressing the OK button. Hitting
|
|
3170 <Esc> works like pressing the Cancel button.
|
531
|
3171 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
|
7
|
3172
|
519
|
3173 inputlist({textlist}) *inputlist()*
|
819
|
3174 {textlist} must be a |List| of strings. This |List| is
|
|
3175 displayed, one string per line. The user will be prompted to
|
|
3176 enter a number, which is returned.
|
519
|
3177 The user can also select an item by clicking on it with the
|
|
3178 mouse. For the first string 0 is returned. When clicking
|
|
3179 above the first item a negative number is returned. When
|
|
3180 clicking on the prompt one more than the length of {textlist}
|
|
3181 is returned.
|
|
3182 Make sure {textlist} has less then 'lines' entries, otherwise
|
|
3183 it won't work. It's a good idea to put the entry number at
|
|
3184 the start of the string. Example: >
|
|
3185 let color = inputlist(['Select color:', '1. red',
|
|
3186 \ '2. green', '3. blue'])
|
|
3187
|
7
|
3188 inputrestore() *inputrestore()*
|
|
3189 Restore typeahead that was saved with a previous inputsave().
|
|
3190 Should be called the same number of times inputsave() is
|
|
3191 called. Calling it more often is harmless though.
|
|
3192 Returns 1 when there is nothing to restore, 0 otherwise.
|
|
3193
|
|
3194 inputsave() *inputsave()*
|
|
3195 Preserve typeahead (also from mappings) and clear it, so that
|
|
3196 a following prompt gets input from the user. Should be
|
|
3197 followed by a matching inputrestore() after the prompt. Can
|
|
3198 be used several times, in which case there must be just as
|
|
3199 many inputrestore() calls.
|
|
3200 Returns 1 when out of memory, 0 otherwise.
|
|
3201
|
|
3202 inputsecret({prompt} [, {text}]) *inputsecret()*
|
|
3203 This function acts much like the |input()| function with but
|
|
3204 two exceptions:
|
|
3205 a) the user's response will be displayed as a sequence of
|
|
3206 asterisks ("*") thereby keeping the entry secret, and
|
|
3207 b) the user's response will not be recorded on the input
|
|
3208 |history| stack.
|
|
3209 The result is a String, which is whatever the user actually
|
|
3210 typed on the command-line in response to the issued prompt.
|
531
|
3211 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
|
7
|
3212
|
55
|
3213 insert({list}, {item} [, {idx}]) *insert()*
|
685
|
3214 Insert {item} at the start of |List| {list}.
|
55
|
3215 If {idx} is specified insert {item} before the item with index
|
|
3216 {idx}. If {idx} is zero it goes before the first item, just
|
|
3217 like omitting {idx}. A negative {idx} is also possible, see
|
|
3218 |list-index|. -1 inserts just before the last item.
|
685
|
3219 Returns the resulting |List|. Examples: >
|
55
|
3220 :let mylist = insert([2, 3, 5], 1)
|
|
3221 :call insert(mylist, 4, -1)
|
|
3222 :call insert(mylist, 6, len(mylist))
|
82
|
3223 < The last example can be done simpler with |add()|.
|
685
|
3224 Note that when {item} is a |List| it is inserted as a single
|
692
|
3225 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
|
55
|
3226
|
7
|
3227 isdirectory({directory}) *isdirectory()*
|
|
3228 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when a directory
|
|
3229 with the name {directory} exists. If {directory} doesn't
|
|
3230 exist, or isn't a directory, the result is FALSE. {directory}
|
|
3231 is any expression, which is used as a String.
|
|
3232
|
819
|
3233 islocked({expr}) *islocked()* *E786*
|
148
|
3234 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when {expr} is the
|
|
3235 name of a locked variable.
|
685
|
3236 {expr} must be the name of a variable, |List| item or
|
|
3237 |Dictionary| entry, not the variable itself! Example: >
|
148
|
3238 :let alist = [0, ['a', 'b'], 2, 3]
|
|
3239 :lockvar 1 alist
|
|
3240 :echo islocked('alist') " 1
|
|
3241 :echo islocked('alist[1]') " 0
|
|
3242
|
|
3243 < When {expr} is a variable that does not exist you get an error
|
|
3244 message. Use |exists()| to check for existance.
|
|
3245
|
140
|
3246 items({dict}) *items()*
|
685
|
3247 Return a |List| with all the key-value pairs of {dict}. Each
|
|
3248 |List| item is a list with two items: the key of a {dict}
|
|
3249 entry and the value of this entry. The |List| is in arbitrary
|
|
3250 order.
|
140
|
3251
|
95
|
3252
|
|
3253 join({list} [, {sep}]) *join()*
|
|
3254 Join the items in {list} together into one String.
|
|
3255 When {sep} is specified it is put in between the items. If
|
|
3256 {sep} is omitted a single space is used.
|
|
3257 Note that {sep} is not added at the end. You might want to
|
|
3258 add it there too: >
|
|
3259 let lines = join(mylist, "\n") . "\n"
|
692
|
3260 < String items are used as-is. |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are
|
95
|
3261 converted into a string like with |string()|.
|
|
3262 The opposite function is |split()|.
|
|
3263
|
99
|
3264 keys({dict}) *keys()*
|
685
|
3265 Return a |List| with all the keys of {dict}. The |List| is in
|
99
|
3266 arbitrary order.
|
|
3267
|
85
|
3268 *len()* *E701*
|
55
|
3269 len({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the argument.
|
|
3270 When {expr} is a String or a Number the length in bytes is
|
|
3271 used, as with |strlen()|.
|
685
|
3272 When {expr} is a |List| the number of items in the |List| is
|
55
|
3273 returned.
|
685
|
3274 When {expr} is a |Dictionary| the number of entries in the
|
|
3275 |Dictionary| is returned.
|
55
|
3276 Otherwise an error is given.
|
|
3277
|
7
|
3278 *libcall()* *E364* *E368*
|
|
3279 libcall({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
|
|
3280 Call function {funcname} in the run-time library {libname}
|
|
3281 with single argument {argument}.
|
|
3282 This is useful to call functions in a library that you
|
|
3283 especially made to be used with Vim. Since only one argument
|
|
3284 is possible, calling standard library functions is rather
|
|
3285 limited.
|
|
3286 The result is the String returned by the function. If the
|
|
3287 function returns NULL, this will appear as an empty string ""
|
|
3288 to Vim.
|
|
3289 If the function returns a number, use libcallnr()!
|
|
3290 If {argument} is a number, it is passed to the function as an
|
|
3291 int; if {argument} is a string, it is passed as a
|
|
3292 null-terminated string.
|
|
3293 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
|
|
3294
|
|
3295 libcall() allows you to write your own 'plug-in' extensions to
|
|
3296 Vim without having to recompile the program. It is NOT a
|
|
3297 means to call system functions! If you try to do so Vim will
|
|
3298 very probably crash.
|
|
3299
|
|
3300 For Win32, the functions you write must be placed in a DLL
|
|
3301 and use the normal C calling convention (NOT Pascal which is
|
|
3302 used in Windows System DLLs). The function must take exactly
|
|
3303 one parameter, either a character pointer or a long integer,
|
|
3304 and must return a character pointer or NULL. The character
|
|
3305 pointer returned must point to memory that will remain valid
|
|
3306 after the function has returned (e.g. in static data in the
|
|
3307 DLL). If it points to allocated memory, that memory will
|
|
3308 leak away. Using a static buffer in the function should work,
|
|
3309 it's then freed when the DLL is unloaded.
|
|
3310
|
|
3311 WARNING: If the function returns a non-valid pointer, Vim may
|
|
3312 crash! This also happens if the function returns a number,
|
|
3313 because Vim thinks it's a pointer.
|
|
3314 For Win32 systems, {libname} should be the filename of the DLL
|
|
3315 without the ".DLL" suffix. A full path is only required if
|
|
3316 the DLL is not in the usual places.
|
|
3317 For Unix: When compiling your own plugins, remember that the
|
|
3318 object code must be compiled as position-independent ('PIC').
|
|
3319 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
|
|
3320 feature is present}
|
|
3321 Examples: >
|
|
3322 :echo libcall("libc.so", "getenv", "HOME")
|
|
3323 :echo libcallnr("/usr/lib/libc.so", "getpid", "")
|
|
3324 <
|
|
3325 *libcallnr()*
|
|
3326 libcallnr({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
|
|
3327 Just like libcall(), but used for a function that returns an
|
|
3328 int instead of a string.
|
|
3329 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
|
|
3330 feature is present}
|
|
3331 Example (not very useful...): >
|
|
3332 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "printf", "Hello World!\n")
|
|
3333 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "sleep", 10)
|
|
3334 <
|
|
3335 *line()*
|
|
3336 line({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the line number of the file
|
|
3337 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
|
|
3338 . the cursor position
|
|
3339 $ the last line in the current buffer
|
|
3340 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
3341 returned)
|
665
|
3342 w0 first line visible in current window
|
|
3343 w$ last line visible in current window
|
707
|
3344 Note that a mark in another file can be used.
|
703
|
3345 To get the column number use |col()|. To get both use
|
|
3346 |getpos()|.
|
7
|
3347 Examples: >
|
|
3348 line(".") line number of the cursor
|
|
3349 line("'t") line number of mark t
|
|
3350 line("'" . marker) line number of mark marker
|
|
3351 < *last-position-jump*
|
|
3352 This autocommand jumps to the last known position in a file
|
|
3353 just after opening it, if the '" mark is set: >
|
|
3354 :au BufReadPost * if line("'\"") > 0 && line("'\"") <= line("$") | exe "normal g'\"" | endif
|
9
|
3355
|
7
|
3356 line2byte({lnum}) *line2byte()*
|
|
3357 Return the byte count from the start of the buffer for line
|
|
3358 {lnum}. This includes the end-of-line character, depending on
|
|
3359 the 'fileformat' option for the current buffer. The first
|
|
3360 line returns 1.
|
|
3361 This can also be used to get the byte count for the line just
|
|
3362 below the last line: >
|
|
3363 line2byte(line("$") + 1)
|
|
3364 < This is the file size plus one.
|
|
3365 When {lnum} is invalid, or the |+byte_offset| feature has been
|
|
3366 disabled at compile time, -1 is returned.
|
|
3367 Also see |byte2line()|, |go| and |:goto|.
|
|
3368
|
|
3369 lispindent({lnum}) *lispindent()*
|
|
3370 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the lisp
|
|
3371 indenting rules, as with 'lisp'.
|
|
3372 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
|
|
3373 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
|
|
3374 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the
|
|
3375 |+lispindent| feature, -1 is returned.
|
|
3376
|
|
3377 localtime() *localtime()*
|
|
3378 Return the current time, measured as seconds since 1st Jan
|
|
3379 1970. See also |strftime()| and |getftime()|.
|
|
3380
|
95
|
3381
|
102
|
3382 map({expr}, {string}) *map()*
|
685
|
3383 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
3384 Replace each item in {expr} with the result of evaluating
|
|
3385 {string}.
|
|
3386 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
|
685
|
3387 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
|
102
|
3388 Example: >
|
|
3389 :call map(mylist, '"> " . v:val . " <"')
|
95
|
3390 < This puts "> " before and " <" after each item in "mylist".
|
102
|
3391
|
158
|
3392 Note that {string} is the result of an expression and is then
|
102
|
3393 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
|
158
|
3394 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes. You
|
|
3395 still have to double ' quotes
|
102
|
3396
|
685
|
3397 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
|
|
3398 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
99
|
3399 :let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' & . "\t"')
|
102
|
3400
|
685
|
3401 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
|
648
|
3402 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
|
|
3403 further items in {expr} are processed.
|
95
|
3404
|
|
3405
|
782
|
3406 maparg({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *maparg()*
|
7
|
3407 Return the rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}. When there
|
|
3408 is no mapping for {name}, an empty String is returned.
|
644
|
3409 {mode} can be one of these strings:
|
7
|
3410 "n" Normal
|
|
3411 "v" Visual
|
|
3412 "o" Operator-pending
|
|
3413 "i" Insert
|
|
3414 "c" Cmd-line
|
|
3415 "l" langmap |language-mapping|
|
|
3416 "" Normal, Visual and Operator-pending
|
644
|
3417 When {mode} is omitted, the modes for "" are used.
|
782
|
3418 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
|
3419 instead of mappings.
|
7
|
3420 The {name} can have special key names, like in the ":map"
|
|
3421 command. The returned String has special characters
|
|
3422 translated like in the output of the ":map" command listing.
|
|
3423 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
|
|
3424 then the global mappings.
|
626
|
3425 This function can be used to map a key even when it's already
|
|
3426 mapped, and have it do the original mapping too. Sketch: >
|
|
3427 exe 'nnoremap <Tab> ==' . maparg('<Tab>', 'n')
|
|
3428
|
7
|
3429
|
782
|
3430 mapcheck({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *mapcheck()*
|
7
|
3431 Check if there is a mapping that matches with {name} in mode
|
|
3432 {mode}. See |maparg()| for {mode} and special names in
|
|
3433 {name}.
|
782
|
3434 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
|
3435 instead of mappings.
|
7
|
3436 A match happens with a mapping that starts with {name} and
|
|
3437 with a mapping which is equal to the start of {name}.
|
|
3438
|
|
3439 matches mapping "a" "ab" "abc" ~
|
|
3440 mapcheck("a") yes yes yes
|
|
3441 mapcheck("abc") yes yes yes
|
|
3442 mapcheck("ax") yes no no
|
|
3443 mapcheck("b") no no no
|
|
3444
|
|
3445 The difference with maparg() is that mapcheck() finds a
|
|
3446 mapping that matches with {name}, while maparg() only finds a
|
|
3447 mapping for {name} exactly.
|
|
3448 When there is no mapping that starts with {name}, an empty
|
|
3449 String is returned. If there is one, the rhs of that mapping
|
|
3450 is returned. If there are several mappings that start with
|
|
3451 {name}, the rhs of one of them is returned.
|
|
3452 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
|
|
3453 then the global mappings.
|
|
3454 This function can be used to check if a mapping can be added
|
|
3455 without being ambiguous. Example: >
|
|
3456 :if mapcheck("_vv") == ""
|
|
3457 : map _vv :set guifont=7x13<CR>
|
|
3458 :endif
|
|
3459 < This avoids adding the "_vv" mapping when there already is a
|
|
3460 mapping for "_v" or for "_vvv".
|
|
3461
|
19
|
3462 match({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *match()*
|
685
|
3463 When {expr} is a |List| then this returns the index of the
|
|
3464 first item where {pat} matches. Each item is used as a
|
692
|
3465 String, |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are used as echoed.
|
95
|
3466 Otherwise, {expr} is used as a String. The result is a
|
|
3467 Number, which gives the index (byte offset) in {expr} where
|
|
3468 {pat} matches.
|
685
|
3469 A match at the first character or |List| item returns zero.
|
19
|
3470 If there is no match -1 is returned.
|
|
3471 Example: >
|
95
|
3472 :echo match("testing", "ing") " results in 4
|
714
|
3473 :echo match([1, 'x'], '\a') " results in 1
|
95
|
3474 < See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
|
170
|
3475 *strpbrk()*
|
|
3476 Vim doesn't have a strpbrk() function. But you can do: >
|
|
3477 :let sepidx = match(line, '[.,;: \t]')
|
|
3478 < *strcasestr()*
|
|
3479 Vim doesn't have a strcasestr() function. But you can add
|
|
3480 "\c" to the pattern to ignore case: >
|
|
3481 :let idx = match(haystack, '\cneedle')
|
|
3482 <
|
95
|
3483 If {start} is given, the search starts from byte index
|
685
|
3484 {start} in a String or item {start} in a |List|.
|
7
|
3485 The result, however, is still the index counted from the
|
236
|
3486 first character/item. Example: >
|
7
|
3487 :echo match("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3488 < result is again "4". >
|
|
3489 :echo match("testing", "ing", 4)
|
|
3490 < result is again "4". >
|
|
3491 :echo match("testing", "t", 2)
|
|
3492 < result is "3".
|
694
|
3493 For a String, if {start} > 0 then it is like the string starts
|
703
|
3494 {start} bytes later, thus "^" will match at {start}. Except
|
|
3495 when {count} is given, then it's like matches before the
|
|
3496 {start} byte are ignored (this is a bit complicated to keep it
|
|
3497 backwards compatible).
|
95
|
3498 For a String, if {start} < 0, it will be set to 0. For a list
|
|
3499 the index is counted from the end.
|
697
|
3500 If {start} is out of range ({start} > strlen({expr}) for a
|
|
3501 String or {start} > len({expr}) for a |List|) -1 is returned.
|
95
|
3502
|
694
|
3503 When {count} is given use the {count}'th match. When a match
|
697
|
3504 is found in a String the search for the next one starts one
|
694
|
3505 character further. Thus this example results in 1: >
|
|
3506 echo match("testing", "..", 0, 2)
|
|
3507 < In a |List| the search continues in the next item.
|
703
|
3508 Note that when {count} is added the way {start} works changes,
|
|
3509 see above.
|
694
|
3510
|
7
|
3511 See |pattern| for the patterns that are accepted.
|
|
3512 The 'ignorecase' option is used to set the ignore-caseness of
|
|
3513 the pattern. 'smartcase' is NOT used. The matching is always
|
|
3514 done like 'magic' is set and 'cpoptions' is empty.
|
|
3515
|
819
|
3516
|
|
3517 matcharg({nr}) *matcharg()*
|
|
3518 Selects the {nr} match item, as set with a |:match|,
|
|
3519 |:2match| or |:3match| command.
|
|
3520 Return a |List| with two elements:
|
|
3521 The name of the highlight group used
|
|
3522 The pattern used.
|
|
3523 When {nr} is not 1, 2 or 3 returns an empty |List|.
|
|
3524 When there is no match item set returns ['', ''].
|
|
3525 This is usef to save and restore a |:match|.
|
|
3526
|
|
3527
|
19
|
3528 matchend({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchend()*
|
7
|
3529 Same as match(), but return the index of first character after
|
|
3530 the match. Example: >
|
|
3531 :echo matchend("testing", "ing")
|
|
3532 < results in "7".
|
170
|
3533 *strspn()* *strcspn()*
|
|
3534 Vim doesn't have a strspn() or strcspn() function, but you can
|
|
3535 do it with matchend(): >
|
|
3536 :let span = matchend(line, '[a-zA-Z]')
|
|
3537 :let span = matchend(line, '[^a-zA-Z]')
|
|
3538 < Except that -1 is returned when there are no matches.
|
|
3539
|
7
|
3540 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
|
|
3541 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3542 < results in "7". >
|
|
3543 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 5)
|
|
3544 < result is "-1".
|
685
|
3545 When {expr} is a |List| the result is equal to match().
|
7
|
3546
|
158
|
3547 matchlist({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchlist()*
|
685
|
3548 Same as match(), but return a |List|. The first item in the
|
158
|
3549 list is the matched string, same as what matchstr() would
|
|
3550 return. Following items are submatches, like "\1", "\2", etc.
|
|
3551 in |:substitute|.
|
|
3552 When there is no match an empty list is returned.
|
|
3553
|
19
|
3554 matchstr({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchstr()*
|
7
|
3555 Same as match(), but return the matched string. Example: >
|
|
3556 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing")
|
|
3557 < results in "ing".
|
|
3558 When there is no match "" is returned.
|
|
3559 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
|
|
3560 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3561 < results in "ing". >
|
|
3562 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 5)
|
|
3563 < result is "".
|
685
|
3564 When {expr} is a |List| then the matching item is returned.
|
95
|
3565 The type isn't changed, it's not necessarily a String.
|
7
|
3566
|
87
|
3567 *max()*
|
|
3568 max({list}) Return the maximum value of all items in {list}.
|
|
3569 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
|
|
3570 be used as a Number this results in an error.
|
685
|
3571 An empty |List| results in zero.
|
87
|
3572
|
|
3573 *min()*
|
|
3574 min({list}) Return the minumum value of all items in {list}.
|
|
3575 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
|
|
3576 be used as a Number this results in an error.
|
685
|
3577 An empty |List| results in zero.
|
87
|
3578
|
168
|
3579 *mkdir()* *E749*
|
|
3580 mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
|
|
3581 Create directory {name}.
|
|
3582 If {path} is "p" then intermediate directories are created as
|
|
3583 necessary. Otherwise it must be "".
|
|
3584 If {prot} is given it is used to set the protection bits of
|
|
3585 the new directory. The default is 0755 (rwxr-xr-x: r/w for
|
|
3586 the user readable for others). Use 0700 to make it unreadable
|
|
3587 for others.
|
|
3588 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3589 Not available on all systems. To check use: >
|
|
3590 :if exists("*mkdir")
|
|
3591 <
|
7
|
3592 *mode()*
|
|
3593 mode() Return a string that indicates the current mode:
|
|
3594 n Normal
|
|
3595 v Visual by character
|
|
3596 V Visual by line
|
|
3597 CTRL-V Visual blockwise
|
|
3598 s Select by character
|
|
3599 S Select by line
|
|
3600 CTRL-S Select blockwise
|
|
3601 i Insert
|
|
3602 R Replace
|
|
3603 c Command-line
|
|
3604 r Hit-enter prompt
|
|
3605 This is useful in the 'statusline' option. In most other
|
|
3606 places it always returns "c" or "n".
|
|
3607
|
|
3608 nextnonblank({lnum}) *nextnonblank()*
|
|
3609 Return the line number of the first line at or below {lnum}
|
|
3610 that is not blank. Example: >
|
|
3611 if getline(nextnonblank(1)) =~ "Java"
|
|
3612 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
|
|
3613 below it, zero is returned.
|
|
3614 See also |prevnonblank()|.
|
|
3615
|
|
3616 nr2char({expr}) *nr2char()*
|
|
3617 Return a string with a single character, which has the number
|
|
3618 value {expr}. Examples: >
|
|
3619 nr2char(64) returns "@"
|
|
3620 nr2char(32) returns " "
|
|
3621 < The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
|
|
3622 nr2char(300) returns I with bow character
|
|
3623 < Note that a NUL character in the file is specified with
|
|
3624 nr2char(10), because NULs are represented with newline
|
|
3625 characters. nr2char(0) is a real NUL and terminates the
|
119
|
3626 string, thus results in an empty string.
|
7
|
3627
|
703
|
3628 *getpos()*
|
707
|
3629 getpos({expr}) Get the position for {expr}. For possible values of {expr}
|
|
3630 see |line()|.
|
|
3631 The result is a |List| with four numbers:
|
|
3632 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
|
|
3633 "bufnum" is zero, unless a mark like '0 or 'A is used, then it
|
|
3634 is the buffer number of the mark.
|
|
3635 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
|
|
3636 column is 1.
|
703
|
3637 The "off" number is zero, unless 'virtualedit' is used. Then
|
|
3638 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
3639 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
3640 character.
|
|
3641 This can be used to save and restore the cursor position: >
|
|
3642 let save_cursor = getpos(".")
|
|
3643 MoveTheCursorAround
|
798
|
3644 call setpos('.', save_cursor)
|
707
|
3645 < Also see |setpos()|.
|
703
|
3646
|
819
|
3647 pathshorten({expr}) *pathshorten()*
|
|
3648 Shorten directory names in the path {expr} and return the
|
|
3649 result. The tail, the file name, is kept as-is. The other
|
|
3650 components in the path are reduced to single letters. Leading
|
|
3651 '~' and '.' characters are kept. Example: >
|
|
3652 :echo pathshorten('~/.vim/autoload/myfile.vim')
|
|
3653 < ~/.v/a/myfile.vim ~
|
|
3654 It doesn't matter if the path exists or not.
|
|
3655
|
667
|
3656 prevnonblank({lnum}) *prevnonblank()*
|
|
3657 Return the line number of the first line at or above {lnum}
|
|
3658 that is not blank. Example: >
|
|
3659 let ind = indent(prevnonblank(v:lnum - 1))
|
|
3660 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
|
|
3661 above it, zero is returned.
|
|
3662 Also see |nextnonblank()|.
|
|
3663
|
|
3664
|
449
|
3665 printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()*
|
|
3666 Return a String with {fmt}, where "%" items are replaced by
|
|
3667 the formatted form of their respective arguments. Example: >
|
452
|
3668 printf("%4d: E%d %.30s", lnum, errno, msg)
|
449
|
3669 < May result in:
|
452
|
3670 " 99: E42 asdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfas" ~
|
449
|
3671
|
|
3672 Often used items are:
|
|
3673 %s string
|
653
|
3674 %6s string right-aligned in 6 bytes
|
|
3675 %.9s string truncated to 9 bytes
|
452
|
3676 %c single byte
|
449
|
3677 %d decimal number
|
|
3678 %5d decimal number padded with spaces to 5 characters
|
|
3679 %x hex number
|
|
3680 %04x hex number padded with zeros to at least 4 characters
|
|
3681 %X hex number using upper case letters
|
|
3682 %o octal number
|
653
|
3683 %% the % character itself
|
449
|
3684
|
|
3685 Conversion specifications start with '%' and end with the
|
|
3686 conversion type. All other characters are copied unchanged to
|
|
3687 the result.
|
|
3688
|
|
3689 The "%" starts a conversion specification. The following
|
452
|
3690 arguments appear in sequence:
|
|
3691
|
|
3692 % [flags] [field-width] [.precision] type
|
|
3693
|
|
3694 flags
|
|
3695 Zero or more of the following flags:
|
|
3696
|
449
|
3697 # The value should be converted to an "alternate
|
|
3698 form". For c, d, and s conversions, this option
|
|
3699 has no effect. For o conversions, the precision
|
|
3700 of the number is increased to force the first
|
|
3701 character of the output string to a zero (except
|
|
3702 if a zero value is printed with an explicit
|
|
3703 precision of zero).
|
|
3704 For x and X conversions, a non-zero result has
|
|
3705 the string "0x" (or "0X" for X conversions)
|
|
3706 prepended to it.
|
452
|
3707
|
449
|
3708 0 (zero) Zero padding. For all conversions the converted
|
|
3709 value is padded on the left with zeros rather
|
|
3710 than blanks. If a precision is given with a
|
|
3711 numeric conversion (d, o, x, and X), the 0 flag
|
|
3712 is ignored.
|
452
|
3713
|
449
|
3714 - A negative field width flag; the converted value
|
|
3715 is to be left adjusted on the field boundary.
|
|
3716 The converted value is padded on the right with
|
|
3717 blanks, rather than on the left with blanks or
|
|
3718 zeros. A - overrides a 0 if both are given.
|
452
|
3719
|
449
|
3720 ' ' (space) A blank should be left before a positive
|
|
3721 number produced by a signed conversion (d).
|
452
|
3722
|
449
|
3723 + A sign must always be placed before a number
|
|
3724 produced by a signed conversion. A + overrides
|
|
3725 a space if both are used.
|
452
|
3726
|
|
3727 field-width
|
|
3728 An optional decimal digit string specifying a minimum
|
653
|
3729 field width. If the converted value has fewer bytes
|
|
3730 than the field width, it will be padded with spaces on
|
|
3731 the left (or right, if the left-adjustment flag has
|
|
3732 been given) to fill out the field width.
|
452
|
3733
|
|
3734 .precision
|
|
3735 An optional precision, in the form of a period '.'
|
|
3736 followed by an optional digit string. If the digit
|
|
3737 string is omitted, the precision is taken as zero.
|
|
3738 This gives the minimum number of digits to appear for
|
|
3739 d, o, x, and X conversions, or the maximum number of
|
653
|
3740 bytes to be printed from a string for s conversions.
|
452
|
3741
|
|
3742 type
|
|
3743 A character that specifies the type of conversion to
|
|
3744 be applied, see below.
|
|
3745
|
449
|
3746 A field width or precision, or both, may be indicated by an
|
|
3747 asterisk '*' instead of a digit string. In this case, a
|
|
3748 Number argument supplies the field width or precision. A
|
|
3749 negative field width is treated as a left adjustment flag
|
|
3750 followed by a positive field width; a negative precision is
|
|
3751 treated as though it were missing. Example: >
|
452
|
3752 :echo printf("%d: %.*s", nr, width, line)
|
449
|
3753 < This limits the length of the text used from "line" to
|
452
|
3754 "width" bytes.
|
449
|
3755
|
|
3756 The conversion specifiers and their meanings are:
|
452
|
3757
|
449
|
3758 doxX The Number argument is converted to signed decimal
|
|
3759 (d), unsigned octal (o), or unsigned hexadecimal (x
|
|
3760 and X) notation. The letters "abcdef" are used for
|
|
3761 x conversions; the letters "ABCDEF" are used for X
|
452
|
3762 conversions.
|
|
3763 The precision, if any, gives the minimum number of
|
|
3764 digits that must appear; if the converted value
|
|
3765 requires fewer digits, it is padded on the left with
|
|
3766 zeros.
|
|
3767 In no case does a non-existent or small field width
|
|
3768 cause truncation of a numeric field; if the result of
|
|
3769 a conversion is wider than the field width, the field
|
|
3770 is expanded to contain the conversion result.
|
|
3771
|
|
3772 c The Number argument is converted to a byte, and the
|
|
3773 resulting character is written.
|
|
3774
|
|
3775 s The text of the String argument is used. If a
|
|
3776 precision is specified, no more bytes than the number
|
|
3777 specified are used.
|
|
3778
|
449
|
3779 % A '%' is written. No argument is converted. The
|
|
3780 complete conversion specification is "%%".
|
452
|
3781
|
449
|
3782 Each argument can be Number or String and is converted
|
452
|
3783 automatically to fit the conversion specifier. Any other
|
|
3784 argument type results in an error message.
|
449
|
3785
|
459
|
3786 *E766* *E767*
|
449
|
3787 The number of {exprN} arguments must exactly match the number
|
|
3788 of "%" items. If there are not sufficient or too many
|
452
|
3789 arguments an error is given. Up to 18 arguments can be used.
|
449
|
3790
|
|
3791
|
667
|
3792 pumvisible() *pumvisible()*
|
|
3793 Returns non-zero when the popup menu is visible, zero
|
|
3794 otherwise. See |ins-completion-menu|.
|
712
|
3795 This can be used to avoid some things that would remove the
|
|
3796 popup menu.
|
7
|
3797
|
114
|
3798 *E726* *E727*
|
99
|
3799 range({expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) *range()*
|
685
|
3800 Returns a |List| with Numbers:
|
99
|
3801 - If only {expr} is specified: [0, 1, ..., {expr} - 1]
|
|
3802 - If {max} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + 1, ..., {max}]
|
|
3803 - If {stride} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + {stride}, ...,
|
|
3804 {max}] (increasing {expr} with {stride} each time, not
|
|
3805 producing a value past {max}).
|
336
|
3806 When the maximum is one before the start the result is an
|
|
3807 empty list. When the maximum is more than one before the
|
|
3808 start this is an error.
|
99
|
3809 Examples: >
|
|
3810 range(4) " [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
|
3811 range(2, 4) " [2, 3, 4]
|
|
3812 range(2, 9, 3) " [2, 5, 8]
|
|
3813 range(2, -2, -1) " [2, 1, 0, -1, -2]
|
336
|
3814 range(0) " []
|
|
3815 range(2, 0) " error!
|
99
|
3816 <
|
158
|
3817 *readfile()*
|
168
|
3818 readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
|
685
|
3819 Read file {fname} and return a |List|, each line of the file
|
|
3820 as an item. Lines broken at NL characters. Macintosh files
|
158
|
3821 separated with CR will result in a single long line (unless a
|
|
3822 NL appears somewhere).
|
|
3823 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used:
|
|
3824 - When the last line ends in a NL an extra empty list item is
|
|
3825 added.
|
|
3826 - No CR characters are removed.
|
|
3827 Otherwise:
|
|
3828 - CR characters that appear before a NL are removed.
|
|
3829 - Whether the last line ends in a NL or not does not matter.
|
|
3830 All NUL characters are replaced with a NL character.
|
168
|
3831 When {max} is given this specifies the maximum number of lines
|
|
3832 to be read. Useful if you only want to check the first ten
|
|
3833 lines of a file: >
|
|
3834 :for line in readfile(fname, '', 10)
|
|
3835 : if line =~ 'Date' | echo line | endif
|
|
3836 :endfor
|
233
|
3837 < When {max} is negative -{max} lines from the end of the file
|
|
3838 are returned, or as many as there are.
|
|
3839 When {max} is zero the result is an empty list.
|
168
|
3840 Note that without {max} the whole file is read into memory.
|
|
3841 Also note that there is no recognition of encoding. Read a
|
|
3842 file into a buffer if you need to.
|
158
|
3843 When the file can't be opened an error message is given and
|
|
3844 the result is an empty list.
|
|
3845 Also see |writefile()|.
|
|
3846
|
794
|
3847 reltime([{start} [, {end}]]) *reltime()*
|
|
3848 Return an item that represents a time value. The format of
|
|
3849 the item depends on the system. It can be passed to
|
|
3850 |reltimestr()| to convert it to a string.
|
|
3851 Without an argument it returns the current time.
|
|
3852 With one argument is returns the time passed since the time
|
|
3853 specified in the argument.
|
|
3854 With two arguments it returns the time passed betweein {start}
|
|
3855 and {end}.
|
|
3856 The {start} and {end} arguments must be values returned by
|
|
3857 reltime().
|
|
3858 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
|
|
3859
|
|
3860 reltimestr({time}) *reltimestr()*
|
|
3861 Return a String that represents the time value of {time}.
|
|
3862 This is the number of seconds, a dot and the number of
|
|
3863 microseconds. Example: >
|
|
3864 let start = reltime()
|
|
3865 call MyFunction()
|
|
3866 echo reltimestr(reltime(start))
|
|
3867 < Note that overhead for the commands will be added to the time.
|
|
3868 The accuracy depends on the system.
|
|
3869 Also see |profiling|.
|
|
3870 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
|
|
3871
|
7
|
3872 *remote_expr()* *E449*
|
|
3873 remote_expr({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
3874 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as an
|
|
3875 expression and the result is returned after evaluation.
|
714
|
3876 The result must be a String or a |List|. A |List| is turned
|
|
3877 into a String by joining the items with a line break in
|
|
3878 between (not at the end), like with join(expr, "\n").
|
7
|
3879 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a
|
|
3880 variable and a {serverid} for later use with
|
|
3881 remote_read() is stored there.
|
|
3882 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
|
|
3883 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3884 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3885 Note: Any errors will cause a local error message to be issued
|
|
3886 and the result will be the empty string.
|
|
3887 Examples: >
|
|
3888 :echo remote_expr("gvim", "2+2")
|
|
3889 :echo remote_expr("gvim1", "b:current_syntax")
|
|
3890 <
|
|
3891
|
|
3892 remote_foreground({server}) *remote_foreground()*
|
|
3893 Move the Vim server with the name {server} to the foreground.
|
|
3894 This works like: >
|
|
3895 remote_expr({server}, "foreground()")
|
|
3896 < Except that on Win32 systems the client does the work, to work
|
|
3897 around the problem that the OS doesn't always allow the server
|
|
3898 to bring itself to the foreground.
|
574
|
3899 Note: This does not restore the window if it was minimized,
|
|
3900 like foreground() does.
|
7
|
3901 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3902 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
|
|
3903 Win32 console version}
|
|
3904
|
|
3905
|
|
3906 remote_peek({serverid} [, {retvar}]) *remote_peek()*
|
|
3907 Returns a positive number if there are available strings
|
|
3908 from {serverid}. Copies any reply string into the variable
|
|
3909 {retvar} if specified. {retvar} must be a string with the
|
|
3910 name of a variable.
|
|
3911 Returns zero if none are available.
|
|
3912 Returns -1 if something is wrong.
|
|
3913 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
3914 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3915 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3916 Examples: >
|
|
3917 :let repl = ""
|
|
3918 :echo "PEEK: ".remote_peek(id, "repl").": ".repl
|
|
3919
|
|
3920 remote_read({serverid}) *remote_read()*
|
|
3921 Return the oldest available reply from {serverid} and consume
|
|
3922 it. It blocks until a reply is available.
|
|
3923 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
3924 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3925 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3926 Example: >
|
|
3927 :echo remote_read(id)
|
|
3928 <
|
|
3929 *remote_send()* *E241*
|
|
3930 remote_send({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
22
|
3931 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as input
|
|
3932 keys and the function returns immediately. At the Vim server
|
|
3933 the keys are not mapped |:map|.
|
667
|
3934 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a variable
|
|
3935 and a {serverid} for later use with remote_read() is stored
|
|
3936 there.
|
7
|
3937 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
|
|
3938 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3939 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3940 Note: Any errors will be reported in the server and may mess
|
|
3941 up the display.
|
|
3942 Examples: >
|
|
3943 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":DropAndReply ".file, "serverid").
|
|
3944 \ remote_read(serverid)
|
|
3945
|
|
3946 :autocmd NONE RemoteReply *
|
|
3947 \ echo remote_read(expand("<amatch>"))
|
|
3948 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":sleep 10 | echo ".
|
|
3949 \ 'server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")<CR>')
|
82
|
3950 <
|
79
|
3951 remove({list}, {idx} [, {end}]) *remove()*
|
685
|
3952 Without {end}: Remove the item at {idx} from |List| {list} and
|
79
|
3953 return it.
|
|
3954 With {end}: Remove items from {idx} to {end} (inclusive) and
|
|
3955 return a list with these items. When {idx} points to the same
|
|
3956 item as {end} a list with one item is returned. When {end}
|
|
3957 points to an item before {idx} this is an error.
|
|
3958 See |list-index| for possible values of {idx} and {end}.
|
55
|
3959 Example: >
|
|
3960 :echo "last item: " . remove(mylist, -1)
|
79
|
3961 :call remove(mylist, 0, 9)
|
99
|
3962 remove({dict}, {key})
|
|
3963 Remove the entry from {dict} with key {key}. Example: >
|
|
3964 :echo "removed " . remove(dict, "one")
|
|
3965 < If there is no {key} in {dict} this is an error.
|
|
3966
|
|
3967 Use |delete()| to remove a file.
|
55
|
3968
|
7
|
3969 rename({from}, {to}) *rename()*
|
|
3970 Rename the file by the name {from} to the name {to}. This
|
|
3971 should also work to move files across file systems. The
|
|
3972 result is a Number, which is 0 if the file was renamed
|
|
3973 successfully, and non-zero when the renaming failed.
|
|
3974 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3975
|
18
|
3976 repeat({expr}, {count}) *repeat()*
|
|
3977 Repeat {expr} {count} times and return the concatenated
|
|
3978 result. Example: >
|
|
3979 :let seperator = repeat('-', 80)
|
|
3980 < When {count} is zero or negative the result is empty.
|
685
|
3981 When {expr} is a |List| the result is {expr} concatenated
|
236
|
3982 {count} times. Example: >
|
79
|
3983 :let longlist = repeat(['a', 'b'], 3)
|
|
3984 < Results in ['a', 'b', 'a', 'b', 'a', 'b'].
|
18
|
3985
|
82
|
3986
|
7
|
3987 resolve({filename}) *resolve()* *E655*
|
|
3988 On MS-Windows, when {filename} is a shortcut (a .lnk file),
|
|
3989 returns the path the shortcut points to in a simplified form.
|
|
3990 On Unix, repeat resolving symbolic links in all path
|
|
3991 components of {filename} and return the simplified result.
|
|
3992 To cope with link cycles, resolving of symbolic links is
|
|
3993 stopped after 100 iterations.
|
|
3994 On other systems, return the simplified {filename}.
|
|
3995 The simplification step is done as by |simplify()|.
|
|
3996 resolve() keeps a leading path component specifying the
|
|
3997 current directory (provided the result is still a relative
|
|
3998 path name) and also keeps a trailing path separator.
|
|
3999
|
82
|
4000 *reverse()*
|
|
4001 reverse({list}) Reverse the order of items in {list} in-place. Returns
|
|
4002 {list}.
|
|
4003 If you want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
|
4004 :let revlist = reverse(copy(mylist))
|
|
4005
|
692
|
4006 search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]]) *search()*
|
7
|
4007 Search for regexp pattern {pattern}. The search starts at the
|
119
|
4008 cursor position (you can use |cursor()| to set it).
|
707
|
4009
|
7
|
4010 {flags} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
|
|
4011 'b' search backward instead of forward
|
712
|
4012 'c' accept a match at the cursor position
|
|
4013 'e' move to the End of the match
|
20
|
4014 'n' do Not move the cursor
|
712
|
4015 'p' return number of matching sub-pattern (see below)
|
|
4016 's' set the ' mark at the previous location of the cursor
|
7
|
4017 'w' wrap around the end of the file
|
|
4018 'W' don't wrap around the end of the file
|
|
4019 If neither 'w' or 'W' is given, the 'wrapscan' option applies.
|
|
4020
|
444
|
4021 If the 's' flag is supplied, the ' mark is set, only if the
|
|
4022 cursor is moved. The 's' flag cannot be combined with the 'n'
|
|
4023 flag.
|
|
4024
|
692
|
4025 When the {stopline} argument is given then the search stops
|
|
4026 after searching this line. This is useful to restrict the
|
|
4027 search to a range of lines. Examples: >
|
|
4028 let match = search('(', 'b', line("w0"))
|
|
4029 let end = search('END', '', line("w$"))
|
|
4030 < When {stopline} is used and it is not zero this also implies
|
|
4031 that the search does not wrap around the end of the file.
|
|
4032
|
712
|
4033 If there is no match a 0 is returned and the cursor doesn't
|
|
4034 move. No error message is given.
|
714
|
4035 When a match has been found its line number is returned.
|
|
4036 *search()-sub-match*
|
|
4037 With the 'p' flag the returned value is one more than the
|
|
4038 first sub-match in \(\). One if none of them matched but the
|
|
4039 whole pattern did match.
|
712
|
4040 To get the column number too use |searchpos()|.
|
|
4041
|
20
|
4042 The cursor will be positioned at the match, unless the 'n'
|
707
|
4043 flag is used.
|
7
|
4044
|
|
4045 Example (goes over all files in the argument list): >
|
|
4046 :let n = 1
|
|
4047 :while n <= argc() " loop over all files in arglist
|
|
4048 : exe "argument " . n
|
|
4049 : " start at the last char in the file and wrap for the
|
|
4050 : " first search to find match at start of file
|
|
4051 : normal G$
|
|
4052 : let flags = "w"
|
|
4053 : while search("foo", flags) > 0
|
|
4054 : s/foo/bar/g
|
|
4055 : let flags = "W"
|
|
4056 : endwhile
|
|
4057 : update " write the file if modified
|
|
4058 : let n = n + 1
|
|
4059 :endwhile
|
|
4060 <
|
712
|
4061 Example for using some flags: >
|
|
4062 :echo search('\<if\|\(else\)\|\(endif\)', 'ncpe')
|
|
4063 < This will search for the keywords "if", "else", and "endif"
|
|
4064 under or after the cursor. Because of the 'p' flag, it
|
|
4065 returns 1, 2, or 3 depending on which keyword is found, or 0
|
|
4066 if the search fails. With the cursor on the first word of the
|
|
4067 line:
|
|
4068 if (foo == 0) | let foo = foo + 1 | endif ~
|
|
4069 the function returns 1. Without the 'c' flag, the function
|
|
4070 finds the "endif" and returns 3. The same thing happens
|
|
4071 without the 'e' flag if the cursor is on the "f" of "if".
|
|
4072 The 'n' flag tells the function not to move the cursor.
|
|
4073
|
504
|
4074
|
523
|
4075 searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]]) *searchdecl()*
|
|
4076 Search for the declaration of {name}.
|
|
4077
|
|
4078 With a non-zero {global} argument it works like |gD|, find
|
|
4079 first match in the file. Otherwise it works like |gd|, find
|
|
4080 first match in the function.
|
|
4081
|
|
4082 With a non-zero {thisblock} argument matches in a {} block
|
|
4083 that ends before the cursor position are ignored. Avoids
|
|
4084 finding variable declarations only valid in another scope.
|
|
4085
|
504
|
4086 Moves the cursor to the found match.
|
|
4087 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
|
4088 Example: >
|
|
4089 if searchdecl('myvar') == 0
|
|
4090 echo getline('.')
|
|
4091 endif
|
|
4092 <
|
7
|
4093 *searchpair()*
|
692
|
4094 searchpair({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
7
|
4095 Search for the match of a nested start-end pair. This can be
|
|
4096 used to find the "endif" that matches an "if", while other
|
|
4097 if/endif pairs in between are ignored.
|
677
|
4098 The search starts at the cursor. The default is to search
|
|
4099 forward, include 'b' in {flags} to search backward.
|
|
4100 If a match is found, the cursor is positioned at it and the
|
|
4101 line number is returned. If no match is found 0 or -1 is
|
|
4102 returned and the cursor doesn't move. No error message is
|
|
4103 given.
|
7
|
4104
|
|
4105 {start}, {middle} and {end} are patterns, see |pattern|. They
|
|
4106 must not contain \( \) pairs. Use of \%( \) is allowed. When
|
|
4107 {middle} is not empty, it is found when searching from either
|
|
4108 direction, but only when not in a nested start-end pair. A
|
|
4109 typical use is: >
|
|
4110 searchpair('\<if\>', '\<else\>', '\<endif\>')
|
|
4111 < By leaving {middle} empty the "else" is skipped.
|
|
4112
|
712
|
4113 {flags} 'b', 'c', 'n', 's', 'w' and 'W' are used like with
|
|
4114 |search()|. Additionally:
|
7
|
4115 'r' Repeat until no more matches found; will find the
|
|
4116 outer pair
|
|
4117 'm' return number of Matches instead of line number with
|
712
|
4118 the match; will be > 1 when 'r' is used.
|
7
|
4119
|
|
4120 When a match for {start}, {middle} or {end} is found, the
|
|
4121 {skip} expression is evaluated with the cursor positioned on
|
|
4122 the start of the match. It should return non-zero if this
|
|
4123 match is to be skipped. E.g., because it is inside a comment
|
|
4124 or a string.
|
|
4125 When {skip} is omitted or empty, every match is accepted.
|
|
4126 When evaluating {skip} causes an error the search is aborted
|
|
4127 and -1 returned.
|
|
4128
|
692
|
4129 For {stopline} see |search()|.
|
|
4130
|
7
|
4131 The value of 'ignorecase' is used. 'magic' is ignored, the
|
|
4132 patterns are used like it's on.
|
|
4133
|
|
4134 The search starts exactly at the cursor. A match with
|
|
4135 {start}, {middle} or {end} at the next character, in the
|
|
4136 direction of searching, is the first one found. Example: >
|
|
4137 if 1
|
|
4138 if 2
|
|
4139 endif 2
|
|
4140 endif 1
|
|
4141 < When starting at the "if 2", with the cursor on the "i", and
|
|
4142 searching forwards, the "endif 2" is found. When starting on
|
|
4143 the character just before the "if 2", the "endif 1" will be
|
|
4144 found. That's because the "if 2" will be found first, and
|
|
4145 then this is considered to be a nested if/endif from "if 2" to
|
|
4146 "endif 2".
|
|
4147 When searching backwards and {end} is more than one character,
|
|
4148 it may be useful to put "\zs" at the end of the pattern, so
|
|
4149 that when the cursor is inside a match with the end it finds
|
|
4150 the matching start.
|
|
4151
|
|
4152 Example, to find the "endif" command in a Vim script: >
|
|
4153
|
|
4154 :echo searchpair('\<if\>', '\<el\%[seif]\>', '\<en\%[dif]\>', 'W',
|
|
4155 \ 'getline(".") =~ "^\\s*\""')
|
|
4156
|
|
4157 < The cursor must be at or after the "if" for which a match is
|
|
4158 to be found. Note that single-quote strings are used to avoid
|
|
4159 having to double the backslashes. The skip expression only
|
|
4160 catches comments at the start of a line, not after a command.
|
|
4161 Also, a word "en" or "if" halfway a line is considered a
|
|
4162 match.
|
|
4163 Another example, to search for the matching "{" of a "}": >
|
|
4164
|
|
4165 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW')
|
|
4166
|
|
4167 < This works when the cursor is at or before the "}" for which a
|
|
4168 match is to be found. To reject matches that syntax
|
|
4169 highlighting recognized as strings: >
|
|
4170
|
|
4171 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW',
|
|
4172 \ 'synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 0), "name") =~? "string"')
|
|
4173 <
|
667
|
4174 *searchpairpos()*
|
692
|
4175 searchpairpos({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
685
|
4176 Same as searchpair(), but returns a |List| with the line and
|
|
4177 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
|
|
4178 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
|
667
|
4179 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
|
|
4180 returns [0, 0].
|
|
4181 >
|
|
4182 :let [lnum,col] = searchpairpos('{', '', '}', 'n')
|
|
4183 <
|
|
4184 See |match-parens| for a bigger and more useful example.
|
|
4185
|
692
|
4186 searchpos({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]]) *searchpos()*
|
|
4187 Same as |search()|, but returns a |List| with the line and
|
685
|
4188 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
|
|
4189 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
|
|
4190 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
|
|
4191 returns [0, 0].
|
714
|
4192 Example: >
|
|
4193 :let [lnum, col] = searchpos('mypattern', 'n')
|
|
4194
|
|
4195 < When the 'p' flag is given then there is an extra item with
|
|
4196 the sub-pattern match number |search()-sub-match|. Example: >
|
|
4197 :let [lnum, col, submatch] = searchpos('\(\l\)\|\(\u\)', 'np')
|
|
4198 < In this example "submatch" is 2 when a lowercase letter is
|
|
4199 found |/\l|, 3 when an uppercase letter is found |/\u|.
|
|
4200
|
7
|
4201 server2client( {clientid}, {string}) *server2client()*
|
|
4202 Send a reply string to {clientid}. The most recent {clientid}
|
|
4203 that sent a string can be retrieved with expand("<client>").
|
|
4204 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
4205 Note:
|
|
4206 This id has to be stored before the next command can be
|
236
|
4207 received. I.e. before returning from the received command and
|
7
|
4208 before calling any commands that waits for input.
|
|
4209 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
4210 Example: >
|
|
4211 :echo server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")
|
|
4212 <
|
|
4213 serverlist() *serverlist()*
|
|
4214 Return a list of available server names, one per line.
|
|
4215 When there are no servers or the information is not available
|
|
4216 an empty string is returned. See also |clientserver|.
|
|
4217 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
4218 Example: >
|
|
4219 :echo serverlist()
|
|
4220 <
|
|
4221 setbufvar({expr}, {varname}, {val}) *setbufvar()*
|
|
4222 Set option or local variable {varname} in buffer {expr} to
|
|
4223 {val}.
|
|
4224 This also works for a global or local window option, but it
|
|
4225 doesn't work for a global or local window variable.
|
|
4226 For a local window option the global value is unchanged.
|
|
4227 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
4228 Note that the variable name without "b:" must be used.
|
|
4229 Examples: >
|
|
4230 :call setbufvar(1, "&mod", 1)
|
|
4231 :call setbufvar("todo", "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4232 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
4233
|
|
4234 setcmdpos({pos}) *setcmdpos()*
|
|
4235 Set the cursor position in the command line to byte position
|
|
4236 {pos}. The first position is 1.
|
|
4237 Use |getcmdpos()| to obtain the current position.
|
|
4238 Only works while editing the command line, thus you must use
|
99
|
4239 |c_CTRL-\_e|, |c_CTRL-R_=| or |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '='. For
|
|
4240 |c_CTRL-\_e| and |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '=' the position is
|
|
4241 set after the command line is set to the expression. For
|
|
4242 |c_CTRL-R_=| it is set after evaluating the expression but
|
|
4243 before inserting the resulting text.
|
7
|
4244 When the number is too big the cursor is put at the end of the
|
|
4245 line. A number smaller than one has undefined results.
|
|
4246 Returns 0 when successful, 1 when not editing the command
|
|
4247 line.
|
|
4248
|
|
4249 setline({lnum}, {line}) *setline()*
|
236
|
4250 Set line {lnum} of the current buffer to {line}.
|
|
4251 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|.
|
282
|
4252 When {lnum} is just below the last line the {line} will be
|
|
4253 added as a new line.
|
236
|
4254 If this succeeds, 0 is returned. If this fails (most likely
|
|
4255 because {lnum} is invalid) 1 is returned. Example: >
|
7
|
4256 :call setline(5, strftime("%c"))
|
685
|
4257 < When {line} is a |List| then line {lnum} and following lines
|
282
|
4258 will be set to the items in the list. Example: >
|
|
4259 :call setline(5, ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc'])
|
|
4260 < This is equivalent to: >
|
|
4261 :for [n, l] in [[5, 6, 7], ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc']]
|
|
4262 : call setline(n, l)
|
|
4263 :endfor
|
7
|
4264 < Note: The '[ and '] marks are not set.
|
|
4265
|
647
|
4266 setloclist({nr}, {list} [, {action}]) *setloclist()*
|
|
4267 Create or replace or add to the location list for window {nr}.
|
|
4268 When {nr} is zero the current window is used. For a location
|
648
|
4269 list window, the displayed location list is modified. For an
|
|
4270 invalid window number {nr}, -1 is returned.
|
647
|
4271 Otherwise, same as setqflist().
|
230
|
4272
|
707
|
4273 *setpos()*
|
|
4274 setpos({expr}, {list})
|
|
4275 Set the position for {expr}. Possible values:
|
|
4276 . the cursor
|
|
4277 'x mark x
|
|
4278
|
|
4279 {list} must be a |List| with four numbers:
|
|
4280 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
|
|
4281
|
|
4282 "bufnum" is the buffer number. Zero can be used for the
|
|
4283 current buffer. Setting the cursor is only possible for
|
|
4284 the current buffer. To set a mark in another buffer you can
|
|
4285 use the |bufnr()| function to turn a file name into a buffer
|
|
4286 number.
|
798
|
4287 Does not change the jumplist.
|
707
|
4288
|
|
4289 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
|
|
4290 column is 1. Use a zero "lnum" to delete a mark.
|
|
4291
|
|
4292 The "off" number is only used when 'virtualedit' is set. Then
|
|
4293 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
4294 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
4295 character.
|
|
4296
|
|
4297 Also see |getpos()|
|
|
4298
|
|
4299
|
277
|
4300 setqflist({list} [, {action}]) *setqflist()*
|
647
|
4301 Create or replace or add to the quickfix list using the items
|
|
4302 in {list}. Each item in {list} is a dictionary.
|
|
4303 Non-dictionary items in {list} are ignored. Each dictionary
|
|
4304 item can contain the following entries:
|
230
|
4305
|
|
4306 filename name of a file
|
|
4307 lnum line number in the file
|
233
|
4308 pattern search pattern used to locate the error
|
230
|
4309 col column number
|
233
|
4310 vcol when non-zero: "col" is visual column
|
|
4311 when zero: "col" is byte index
|
|
4312 nr error number
|
230
|
4313 text description of the error
|
233
|
4314 type single-character error type, 'E', 'W', etc.
|
|
4315
|
|
4316 The "col", "vcol", "nr", "type" and "text" entries are
|
|
4317 optional. Either "lnum" or "pattern" entry can be used to
|
|
4318 locate a matching error line.
|
230
|
4319 If the "filename" entry is not present or neither the "lnum"
|
|
4320 or "pattern" entries are present, then the item will not be
|
|
4321 handled as an error line.
|
|
4322 If both "pattern" and "lnum" are present then "pattern" will
|
|
4323 be used.
|
|
4324
|
277
|
4325 If {action} is set to 'a', then the items from {list} are
|
|
4326 added to the existing quickfix list. If there is no existing
|
|
4327 list, then a new list is created. If {action} is set to 'r',
|
|
4328 then the items from the current quickfix list are replaced
|
|
4329 with the items from {list}. If {action} is not present or is
|
|
4330 set to ' ', then a new list is created.
|
|
4331
|
230
|
4332 Returns zero for success, -1 for failure.
|
|
4333
|
|
4334 This function can be used to create a quickfix list
|
|
4335 independent of the 'errorformat' setting. Use a command like
|
|
4336 ":cc 1" to jump to the first position.
|
|
4337
|
|
4338
|
7
|
4339 *setreg()*
|
|
4340 setreg({regname}, {value} [,{options}])
|
|
4341 Set the register {regname} to {value}.
|
|
4342 If {options} contains "a" or {regname} is upper case,
|
|
4343 then the value is appended.
|
|
4344 {options} can also contains a register type specification:
|
|
4345 "c" or "v" |characterwise| mode
|
|
4346 "l" or "V" |linewise| mode
|
|
4347 "b" or "<CTRL-V>" |blockwise-visual| mode
|
|
4348 If a number immediately follows "b" or "<CTRL-V>" then this is
|
|
4349 used as the width of the selection - if it is not specified
|
|
4350 then the width of the block is set to the number of characters
|
|
4351 in the longest line (counting a <TAB> as 1 character).
|
|
4352
|
|
4353 If {options} contains no register settings, then the default
|
|
4354 is to use character mode unless {value} ends in a <NL>.
|
|
4355 Setting the '=' register is not possible.
|
|
4356 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
|
4357
|
|
4358 Examples: >
|
|
4359 :call setreg(v:register, @*)
|
|
4360 :call setreg('*', @%, 'ac')
|
|
4361 :call setreg('a', "1\n2\n3", 'b5')
|
|
4362
|
|
4363 < This example shows using the functions to save and restore a
|
|
4364 register. >
|
282
|
4365 :let var_a = getreg('a', 1)
|
7
|
4366 :let var_amode = getregtype('a')
|
|
4367 ....
|
|
4368 :call setreg('a', var_a, var_amode)
|
|
4369
|
|
4370 < You can also change the type of a register by appending
|
|
4371 nothing: >
|
|
4372 :call setreg('a', '', 'al')
|
|
4373
|
831
|
4374 settabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) *settabwinvar()*
|
|
4375 Set option or local variable {varname} in window {winnr} to
|
|
4376 {val}.
|
|
4377 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
|
|
4378 use |setwinvar()|.
|
|
4379 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
|
7
|
4380 This also works for a global or local buffer option, but it
|
|
4381 doesn't work for a global or local buffer variable.
|
|
4382 For a local buffer option the global value is unchanged.
|
|
4383 Note that the variable name without "w:" must be used.
|
831
|
4384 Vim briefly goes to the tab page {tabnr}, this may trigger
|
|
4385 TabLeave and TabEnter autocommands.
|
|
4386 Examples: >
|
|
4387 :call settabwinvar(1, 1, "&list", 0)
|
|
4388 :call settabwinvar(3, 2, "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4389 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
4390
|
|
4391 setwinvar({nr}, {varname}, {val}) *setwinvar()*
|
|
4392 Like |settabwinvar()| for the current tab page.
|
7
|
4393 Examples: >
|
|
4394 :call setwinvar(1, "&list", 0)
|
|
4395 :call setwinvar(2, "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4396
|
|
4397 simplify({filename}) *simplify()*
|
|
4398 Simplify the file name as much as possible without changing
|
|
4399 the meaning. Shortcuts (on MS-Windows) or symbolic links (on
|
|
4400 Unix) are not resolved. If the first path component in
|
|
4401 {filename} designates the current directory, this will be
|
|
4402 valid for the result as well. A trailing path separator is
|
|
4403 not removed either.
|
|
4404 Example: >
|
|
4405 simplify("./dir/.././/file/") == "./file/"
|
|
4406 < Note: The combination "dir/.." is only removed if "dir" is
|
|
4407 a searchable directory or does not exist. On Unix, it is also
|
|
4408 removed when "dir" is a symbolic link within the same
|
|
4409 directory. In order to resolve all the involved symbolic
|
|
4410 links before simplifying the path name, use |resolve()|.
|
|
4411
|
82
|
4412
|
85
|
4413 sort({list} [, {func}]) *sort()* *E702*
|
82
|
4414 Sort the items in {list} in-place. Returns {list}. If you
|
|
4415 want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
|
4416 :let sortedlist = sort(copy(mylist))
|
|
4417 < Uses the string representation of each item to sort on.
|
692
|
4418 Numbers sort after Strings, |Lists| after Numbers.
|
282
|
4419 For sorting text in the current buffer use |:sort|.
|
82
|
4420 When {func} is given and it is one then case is ignored.
|
685
|
4421 When {func} is a |Funcref| or a function name, this function
|
|
4422 is called to compare items. The function is invoked with two
|
82
|
4423 items as argument and must return zero if they are equal, 1 if
|
|
4424 the first one sorts after the second one, -1 if the first one
|
|
4425 sorts before the second one. Example: >
|
|
4426 func MyCompare(i1, i2)
|
|
4427 return a:i1 == a:i2 ? 0 : a:i1 > a:i2 ? 1 : -1
|
|
4428 endfunc
|
|
4429 let sortedlist = sort(mylist, "MyCompare")
|
344
|
4430 <
|
|
4431
|
374
|
4432 *soundfold()*
|
|
4433 soundfold({word})
|
|
4434 Return the sound-folded equivalent of {word}. Uses the first
|
|
4435 language in 'spellang' for the current window that supports
|
375
|
4436 soundfolding. 'spell' must be set. When no sound folding is
|
|
4437 possible the {word} is returned unmodified.
|
374
|
4438 This can be used for making spelling suggestions. Note that
|
|
4439 the method can be quite slow.
|
|
4440
|
344
|
4441 *spellbadword()*
|
532
|
4442 spellbadword([{sentence}])
|
|
4443 Without argument: The result is the badly spelled word under
|
|
4444 or after the cursor. The cursor is moved to the start of the
|
|
4445 bad word. When no bad word is found in the cursor line the
|
|
4446 result is an empty string and the cursor doesn't move.
|
|
4447
|
|
4448 With argument: The result is the first word in {sentence} that
|
|
4449 is badly spelled. If there are no spelling mistakes the
|
|
4450 result is an empty string.
|
|
4451
|
|
4452 The return value is a list with two items:
|
|
4453 - The badly spelled word or an empty string.
|
|
4454 - The type of the spelling error:
|
|
4455 "bad" spelling mistake
|
|
4456 "rare" rare word
|
|
4457 "local" word only valid in another region
|
|
4458 "caps" word should start with Capital
|
|
4459 Example: >
|
|
4460 echo spellbadword("the quik brown fox")
|
|
4461 < ['quik', 'bad'] ~
|
|
4462
|
|
4463 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
|
|
4464 'spell' option must be set and the value of 'spelllang' is
|
|
4465 used.
|
344
|
4466
|
|
4467 *spellsuggest()*
|
537
|
4468 spellsuggest({word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
|
685
|
4469 Return a |List| with spelling suggestions to replace {word}.
|
344
|
4470 When {max} is given up to this number of suggestions are
|
|
4471 returned. Otherwise up to 25 suggestions are returned.
|
|
4472
|
537
|
4473 When the {capital} argument is given and it's non-zero only
|
|
4474 suggestions with a leading capital will be given. Use this
|
|
4475 after a match with 'spellcapcheck'.
|
|
4476
|
344
|
4477 {word} can be a badly spelled word followed by other text.
|
|
4478 This allows for joining two words that were split. The
|
359
|
4479 suggestions also include the following text, thus you can
|
|
4480 replace a line.
|
|
4481
|
|
4482 {word} may also be a good word. Similar words will then be
|
537
|
4483 returned. {word} itself is not included in the suggestions,
|
|
4484 although it may appear capitalized.
|
344
|
4485
|
|
4486 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
|
375
|
4487 'spell' option must be set and the values of 'spelllang' and
|
|
4488 'spellsuggest' are used.
|
344
|
4489
|
82
|
4490
|
282
|
4491 split({expr} [, {pattern} [, {keepempty}]]) *split()*
|
685
|
4492 Make a |List| out of {expr}. When {pattern} is omitted or
|
|
4493 empty each white-separated sequence of characters becomes an
|
|
4494 item.
|
82
|
4495 Otherwise the string is split where {pattern} matches,
|
282
|
4496 removing the matched characters.
|
|
4497 When the first or last item is empty it is omitted, unless the
|
|
4498 {keepempty} argument is given and it's non-zero.
|
293
|
4499 Other empty items are kept when {pattern} matches at least one
|
|
4500 character or when {keepempty} is non-zero.
|
82
|
4501 Example: >
|
95
|
4502 :let words = split(getline('.'), '\W\+')
|
282
|
4503 < To split a string in individual characters: >
|
236
|
4504 :for c in split(mystring, '\zs')
|
258
|
4505 < If you want to keep the separator you can also use '\zs': >
|
|
4506 :echo split('abc:def:ghi', ':\zs')
|
|
4507 < ['abc:', 'def:', 'ghi'] ~
|
282
|
4508 Splitting a table where the first element can be empty: >
|
|
4509 :let items = split(line, ':', 1)
|
|
4510 < The opposite function is |join()|.
|
82
|
4511
|
|
4512
|
782
|
4513 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) *str2nr()*
|
|
4514 Convert string {expr} to a number.
|
|
4515 {base} is the conversion base, it can be 8, 10 or 16.
|
|
4516 When {base} is omitted base 10 is used. This also means that
|
|
4517 a leading zero doesn't cause octal conversion to be used, as
|
|
4518 with the default String to Number conversion.
|
|
4519 When {base} is 16 a leading "0x" or "0X" is ignored. With a
|
|
4520 different base the result will be zero.
|
|
4521 Text after the number is silently ignored.
|
|
4522
|
|
4523
|
7
|
4524 strftime({format} [, {time}]) *strftime()*
|
|
4525 The result is a String, which is a formatted date and time, as
|
|
4526 specified by the {format} string. The given {time} is used,
|
|
4527 or the current time if no time is given. The accepted
|
|
4528 {format} depends on your system, thus this is not portable!
|
|
4529 See the manual page of the C function strftime() for the
|
|
4530 format. The maximum length of the result is 80 characters.
|
|
4531 See also |localtime()| and |getftime()|.
|
|
4532 The language can be changed with the |:language| command.
|
|
4533 Examples: >
|
|
4534 :echo strftime("%c") Sun Apr 27 11:49:23 1997
|
|
4535 :echo strftime("%Y %b %d %X") 1997 Apr 27 11:53:25
|
|
4536 :echo strftime("%y%m%d %T") 970427 11:53:55
|
|
4537 :echo strftime("%H:%M") 11:55
|
|
4538 :echo strftime("%c", getftime("file.c"))
|
|
4539 Show mod time of file.c.
|
82
|
4540 < Not available on all systems. To check use: >
|
|
4541 :if exists("*strftime")
|
|
4542
|
133
|
4543 stridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *stridx()*
|
|
4544 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
|
|
4545 {haystack} of the first occurrence of the String {needle}.
|
140
|
4546 If {start} is specified, the search starts at index {start}.
|
|
4547 This can be used to find a second match: >
|
|
4548 :let comma1 = stridx(line, ",")
|
|
4549 :let comma2 = stridx(line, ",", comma1 + 1)
|
|
4550 < The search is done case-sensitive.
|
205
|
4551 For pattern searches use |match()|.
|
133
|
4552 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
|
140
|
4553 See also |strridx()|.
|
|
4554 Examples: >
|
7
|
4555 :echo stridx("An Example", "Example") 3
|
|
4556 :echo stridx("Starting point", "Start") 0
|
|
4557 :echo stridx("Starting point", "start") -1
|
170
|
4558 < *strstr()* *strchr()*
|
|
4559 stridx() works similar to the C function strstr(). When used
|
|
4560 with a single character it works similar to strchr().
|
|
4561
|
55
|
4562 *string()*
|
95
|
4563 string({expr}) Return {expr} converted to a String. If {expr} is a Number,
|
|
4564 String or a composition of them, then the result can be parsed
|
|
4565 back with |eval()|.
|
55
|
4566 {expr} type result ~
|
99
|
4567 String 'string'
|
95
|
4568 Number 123
|
99
|
4569 Funcref function('name')
|
95
|
4570 List [item, item]
|
323
|
4571 Dictionary {key: value, key: value}
|
99
|
4572 Note that in String values the ' character is doubled.
|
55
|
4573
|
7
|
4574 *strlen()*
|
|
4575 strlen({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the String
|
502
|
4576 {expr} in bytes.
|
|
4577 If you want to count the number of multi-byte characters (not
|
|
4578 counting composing characters) use something like this: >
|
7
|
4579
|
|
4580 :let len = strlen(substitute(str, ".", "x", "g"))
|
502
|
4581 <
|
55
|
4582 If the argument is a Number it is first converted to a String.
|
|
4583 For other types an error is given.
|
|
4584 Also see |len()|.
|
7
|
4585
|
|
4586 strpart({src}, {start}[, {len}]) *strpart()*
|
|
4587 The result is a String, which is part of {src}, starting from
|
574
|
4588 byte {start}, with the byte length {len}.
|
7
|
4589 When non-existing bytes are included, this doesn't result in
|
|
4590 an error, the bytes are simply omitted.
|
|
4591 If {len} is missing, the copy continues from {start} till the
|
|
4592 end of the {src}. >
|
|
4593 strpart("abcdefg", 3, 2) == "de"
|
|
4594 strpart("abcdefg", -2, 4) == "ab"
|
|
4595 strpart("abcdefg", 5, 4) == "fg"
|
|
4596 strpart("abcdefg", 3) == "defg"
|
|
4597 < Note: To get the first character, {start} must be 0. For
|
|
4598 example, to get three bytes under and after the cursor: >
|
823
|
4599 strpart(getline("."), col(".") - 1, 3)
|
7
|
4600 <
|
140
|
4601 strridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *strridx()*
|
|
4602 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
|
|
4603 {haystack} of the last occurrence of the String {needle}.
|
|
4604 When {start} is specified, matches beyond this index are
|
|
4605 ignored. This can be used to find a match before a previous
|
|
4606 match: >
|
|
4607 :let lastcomma = strridx(line, ",")
|
|
4608 :let comma2 = strridx(line, ",", lastcomma - 1)
|
|
4609 < The search is done case-sensitive.
|
133
|
4610 For pattern searches use |match()|.
|
|
4611 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
|
22
|
4612 If the {needle} is empty the length of {haystack} is returned.
|
236
|
4613 See also |stridx()|. Examples: >
|
7
|
4614 :echo strridx("an angry armadillo", "an") 3
|
170
|
4615 < *strrchr()*
|
|
4616 When used with a single character it works similar to the C
|
|
4617 function strrchr().
|
|
4618
|
7
|
4619 strtrans({expr}) *strtrans()*
|
|
4620 The result is a String, which is {expr} with all unprintable
|
|
4621 characters translated into printable characters |'isprint'|.
|
|
4622 Like they are shown in a window. Example: >
|
|
4623 echo strtrans(@a)
|
|
4624 < This displays a newline in register a as "^@" instead of
|
|
4625 starting a new line.
|
|
4626
|
|
4627 submatch({nr}) *submatch()*
|
|
4628 Only for an expression in a |:substitute| command. Returns
|
|
4629 the {nr}'th submatch of the matched text. When {nr} is 0
|
|
4630 the whole matched text is returned.
|
|
4631 Example: >
|
|
4632 :s/\d\+/\=submatch(0) + 1/
|
|
4633 < This finds the first number in the line and adds one to it.
|
|
4634 A line break is included as a newline character.
|
|
4635
|
|
4636 substitute({expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) *substitute()*
|
|
4637 The result is a String, which is a copy of {expr}, in which
|
|
4638 the first match of {pat} is replaced with {sub}. This works
|
|
4639 like the ":substitute" command (without any flags). But the
|
|
4640 matching with {pat} is always done like the 'magic' option is
|
|
4641 set and 'cpoptions' is empty (to make scripts portable).
|
|
4642 See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
|
|
4643 And a "~" in {sub} is not replaced with the previous {sub}.
|
|
4644 Note that some codes in {sub} have a special meaning
|
|
4645 |sub-replace-special|. For example, to replace something with
|
|
4646 "\n" (two characters), use "\\\\n" or '\\n'.
|
|
4647 When {pat} does not match in {expr}, {expr} is returned
|
|
4648 unmodified.
|
|
4649 When {flags} is "g", all matches of {pat} in {expr} are
|
|
4650 replaced. Otherwise {flags} should be "".
|
|
4651 Example: >
|
|
4652 :let &path = substitute(&path, ",\\=[^,]*$", "", "")
|
|
4653 < This removes the last component of the 'path' option. >
|
|
4654 :echo substitute("testing", ".*", "\\U\\0", "")
|
|
4655 < results in "TESTING".
|
|
4656
|
32
|
4657 synID({lnum}, {col}, {trans}) *synID()*
|
7
|
4658 The result is a Number, which is the syntax ID at the position
|
32
|
4659 {lnum} and {col} in the current window.
|
7
|
4660 The syntax ID can be used with |synIDattr()| and
|
|
4661 |synIDtrans()| to obtain syntax information about text.
|
419
|
4662
|
32
|
4663 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
|
419
|
4664 line. 'synmaxcol' applies, in a longer line zero is returned.
|
|
4665
|
7
|
4666 When {trans} is non-zero, transparent items are reduced to the
|
|
4667 item that they reveal. This is useful when wanting to know
|
|
4668 the effective color. When {trans} is zero, the transparent
|
|
4669 item is returned. This is useful when wanting to know which
|
|
4670 syntax item is effective (e.g. inside parens).
|
|
4671 Warning: This function can be very slow. Best speed is
|
|
4672 obtained by going through the file in forward direction.
|
|
4673
|
|
4674 Example (echoes the name of the syntax item under the cursor): >
|
|
4675 :echo synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 1), "name")
|
|
4676 <
|
|
4677 synIDattr({synID}, {what} [, {mode}]) *synIDattr()*
|
|
4678 The result is a String, which is the {what} attribute of
|
|
4679 syntax ID {synID}. This can be used to obtain information
|
|
4680 about a syntax item.
|
|
4681 {mode} can be "gui", "cterm" or "term", to get the attributes
|
|
4682 for that mode. When {mode} is omitted, or an invalid value is
|
|
4683 used, the attributes for the currently active highlighting are
|
|
4684 used (GUI, cterm or term).
|
|
4685 Use synIDtrans() to follow linked highlight groups.
|
|
4686 {what} result
|
|
4687 "name" the name of the syntax item
|
|
4688 "fg" foreground color (GUI: color name used to set
|
|
4689 the color, cterm: color number as a string,
|
|
4690 term: empty string)
|
|
4691 "bg" background color (like "fg")
|
|
4692 "fg#" like "fg", but for the GUI and the GUI is
|
|
4693 running the name in "#RRGGBB" form
|
|
4694 "bg#" like "fg#" for "bg"
|
|
4695 "bold" "1" if bold
|
|
4696 "italic" "1" if italic
|
|
4697 "reverse" "1" if reverse
|
|
4698 "inverse" "1" if inverse (= reverse)
|
|
4699 "underline" "1" if underlined
|
205
|
4700 "undercurl" "1" if undercurled
|
7
|
4701
|
|
4702 Example (echoes the color of the syntax item under the
|
|
4703 cursor): >
|
|
4704 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(synID(line("."), col("."), 1)), "fg")
|
|
4705 <
|
|
4706 synIDtrans({synID}) *synIDtrans()*
|
|
4707 The result is a Number, which is the translated syntax ID of
|
|
4708 {synID}. This is the syntax group ID of what is being used to
|
|
4709 highlight the character. Highlight links given with
|
|
4710 ":highlight link" are followed.
|
|
4711
|
24
|
4712 system({expr} [, {input}]) *system()* *E677*
|
|
4713 Get the output of the shell command {expr}.
|
|
4714 When {input} is given, this string is written to a file and
|
|
4715 passed as stdin to the command. The string is written as-is,
|
|
4716 you need to take care of using the correct line separators
|
170
|
4717 yourself. Pipes are not used.
|
24
|
4718 Note: newlines in {expr} may cause the command to fail. The
|
|
4719 characters in 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote' may also cause
|
|
4720 trouble.
|
7
|
4721 This is not to be used for interactive commands.
|
|
4722 The result is a String. Example: >
|
|
4723
|
|
4724 :let files = system("ls")
|
|
4725
|
|
4726 < To make the result more system-independent, the shell output
|
|
4727 is filtered to replace <CR> with <NL> for Macintosh, and
|
|
4728 <CR><NL> with <NL> for DOS-like systems.
|
|
4729 The command executed is constructed using several options:
|
|
4730 'shell' 'shellcmdflag' 'shellxquote' {expr} 'shellredir' {tmp} 'shellxquote'
|
|
4731 ({tmp} is an automatically generated file name).
|
|
4732 For Unix and OS/2 braces are put around {expr} to allow for
|
|
4733 concatenated commands.
|
|
4734
|
794
|
4735 The command will be executed in "cooked" mode, so that a
|
|
4736 CTRL-C will interrupt the command (on Unix at least).
|
|
4737
|
7
|
4738 The resulting error code can be found in |v:shell_error|.
|
|
4739 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
|
625
|
4740
|
|
4741 Note that any wrong value in the options mentioned above may
|
|
4742 make the function fail. It has also been reported to fail
|
|
4743 when using a security agent application.
|
7
|
4744 Unlike ":!cmd" there is no automatic check for changed files.
|
|
4745 Use |:checktime| to force a check.
|
|
4746
|
205
|
4747
|
677
|
4748 tabpagebuflist([{arg}]) *tabpagebuflist()*
|
685
|
4749 The result is a |List|, where each item is the number of the
|
677
|
4750 buffer associated with each window in the current tab page.
|
|
4751 {arg} specifies the number of tab page to be used. When
|
|
4752 omitted the current tab page is used.
|
|
4753 When {arg} is invalid the number zero is returned.
|
|
4754 To get a list of all buffers in all tabs use this: >
|
|
4755 tablist = []
|
|
4756 for i in range(tabpagenr('$'))
|
|
4757 call extend(tablist, tabpagebuflist(i + 1))
|
|
4758 endfor
|
|
4759 < Note that a buffer may appear in more than one window.
|
|
4760
|
|
4761
|
|
4762 tabpagenr([{arg}]) *tabpagenr()*
|
674
|
4763 The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
|
|
4764 tab page. The first tab page has number 1.
|
|
4765 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the last tab
|
|
4766 page is returned (the tab page count).
|
|
4767 The number can be used with the |:tab| command.
|
|
4768
|
|
4769
|
677
|
4770 tabpagewinnr({tabarg}, [{arg}]) *tabpagewinnr()*
|
|
4771 Like |winnr()| but for tab page {arg}.
|
|
4772 {tabarg} specifies the number of tab page to be used.
|
|
4773 {arg} is used like with |winnr()|:
|
|
4774 - When omitted the current window number is returned. This is
|
|
4775 the window which will be used when going to this tab page.
|
|
4776 - When "$" the number of windows is returned.
|
|
4777 - When "#" the previous window nr is returned.
|
|
4778 Useful examples: >
|
|
4779 tabpagewinnr(1) " current window of tab page 1
|
|
4780 tabpagewinnr(4, '$') " number of windows in tab page 4
|
|
4781 < When {tabarg} is invalid zero is returned.
|
|
4782
|
805
|
4783 *tagfiles()*
|
|
4784 tagfiles() Returns a |List| with the file names used to search for tags
|
|
4785 for the current buffer. This is the 'tags' option expanded.
|
|
4786
|
|
4787
|
205
|
4788 taglist({expr}) *taglist()*
|
|
4789 Returns a list of tags matching the regular expression {expr}.
|
438
|
4790 Each list item is a dictionary with at least the following
|
|
4791 entries:
|
648
|
4792 name Name of the tag.
|
|
4793 filename Name of the file where the tag is
|
205
|
4794 defined.
|
|
4795 cmd Ex command used to locate the tag in
|
|
4796 the file.
|
648
|
4797 kind Type of the tag. The value for this
|
205
|
4798 entry depends on the language specific
|
|
4799 kind values generated by the ctags
|
|
4800 tool.
|
648
|
4801 static A file specific tag. Refer to
|
205
|
4802 |static-tag| for more information.
|
216
|
4803 The "kind" entry is only available when using Exuberant ctags
|
|
4804 generated tags file. More entries may be present, depending
|
|
4805 on the content of the tags file: access, implementation,
|
|
4806 inherits and signature. Refer to the ctags documentation for
|
|
4807 information about these fields. For C code the fields
|
|
4808 "struct", "class" and "enum" may appear, they give the name of
|
|
4809 the entity the tag is contained in.
|
452
|
4810
|
216
|
4811 The ex-command 'cmd' can be either an ex search pattern, a
|
|
4812 line number or a line number followed by a byte number.
|
205
|
4813
|
|
4814 If there are no matching tags, then an empty list is returned.
|
|
4815
|
|
4816 To get an exact tag match, the anchors '^' and '$' should be
|
|
4817 used in {expr}. Refer to |tag-regexp| for more information
|
|
4818 about the tag search regular expression pattern.
|
|
4819
|
|
4820 Refer to |'tags'| for information about how the tags file is
|
|
4821 located by Vim. Refer to |tags-file-format| for the format of
|
|
4822 the tags file generated by the different ctags tools.
|
|
4823
|
7
|
4824 tempname() *tempname()* *temp-file-name*
|
|
4825 The result is a String, which is the name of a file that
|
|
4826 doesn't exist. It can be used for a temporary file. The name
|
|
4827 is different for at least 26 consecutive calls. Example: >
|
|
4828 :let tmpfile = tempname()
|
|
4829 :exe "redir > " . tmpfile
|
|
4830 < For Unix, the file will be in a private directory (only
|
|
4831 accessible by the current user) to avoid security problems
|
|
4832 (e.g., a symlink attack or other people reading your file).
|
|
4833 When Vim exits the directory and all files in it are deleted.
|
|
4834 For MS-Windows forward slashes are used when the 'shellslash'
|
|
4835 option is set or when 'shellcmdflag' starts with '-'.
|
|
4836
|
|
4837 tolower({expr}) *tolower()*
|
|
4838 The result is a copy of the String given, with all uppercase
|
|
4839 characters turned into lowercase (just like applying |gu| to
|
|
4840 the string).
|
|
4841
|
|
4842 toupper({expr}) *toupper()*
|
|
4843 The result is a copy of the String given, with all lowercase
|
|
4844 characters turned into uppercase (just like applying |gU| to
|
|
4845 the string).
|
|
4846
|
15
|
4847 tr({src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) *tr()*
|
|
4848 The result is a copy of the {src} string with all characters
|
|
4849 which appear in {fromstr} replaced by the character in that
|
|
4850 position in the {tostr} string. Thus the first character in
|
|
4851 {fromstr} is translated into the first character in {tostr}
|
|
4852 and so on. Exactly like the unix "tr" command.
|
|
4853 This code also deals with multibyte characters properly.
|
|
4854
|
|
4855 Examples: >
|
|
4856 echo tr("hello there", "ht", "HT")
|
|
4857 < returns "Hello THere" >
|
|
4858 echo tr("<blob>", "<>", "{}")
|
|
4859 < returns "{blob}"
|
|
4860
|
87
|
4861 *type()*
|
|
4862 type({expr}) The result is a Number, depending on the type of {expr}:
|
153
|
4863 Number: 0
|
|
4864 String: 1
|
|
4865 Funcref: 2
|
|
4866 List: 3
|
|
4867 Dictionary: 4
|
|
4868 To avoid the magic numbers it should be used this way: >
|
87
|
4869 :if type(myvar) == type(0)
|
|
4870 :if type(myvar) == type("")
|
|
4871 :if type(myvar) == type(function("tr"))
|
|
4872 :if type(myvar) == type([])
|
153
|
4873 :if type(myvar) == type({})
|
7
|
4874
|
140
|
4875 values({dict}) *values()*
|
685
|
4876 Return a |List| with all the values of {dict}. The |List| is
|
|
4877 in arbitrary order.
|
140
|
4878
|
|
4879
|
7
|
4880 virtcol({expr}) *virtcol()*
|
|
4881 The result is a Number, which is the screen column of the file
|
|
4882 position given with {expr}. That is, the last screen position
|
|
4883 occupied by the character at that position, when the screen
|
|
4884 would be of unlimited width. When there is a <Tab> at the
|
|
4885 position, the returned Number will be the column at the end of
|
|
4886 the <Tab>. For example, for a <Tab> in column 1, with 'ts'
|
|
4887 set to 8, it returns 8.
|
685
|
4888 For the use of {expr} see |col()|. Additionally you can use
|
688
|
4889 [lnum, col]: a |List| with the line and column number. When
|
|
4890 "lnum" or "col" is out of range then virtcol() returns zero.
|
703
|
4891 When 'virtualedit' is used it can be [lnum, col, off], where
|
|
4892 "off" is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
4893 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
4894 character.
|
7
|
4895 For the byte position use |col()|.
|
|
4896 When Virtual editing is active in the current mode, a position
|
|
4897 beyond the end of the line can be returned. |'virtualedit'|
|
|
4898 The accepted positions are:
|
|
4899 . the cursor position
|
|
4900 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
|
|
4901 number of displayed characters in the cursor line
|
|
4902 plus one)
|
|
4903 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
4904 returned)
|
|
4905 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
|
|
4906 Examples: >
|
|
4907 virtcol(".") with text "foo^Lbar", with cursor on the "^L", returns 5
|
|
4908 virtcol("$") with text "foo^Lbar", returns 9
|
|
4909 virtcol("'t") with text " there", with 't at 'h', returns 6
|
|
4910 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
|
|
4911
|
|
4912 visualmode([expr]) *visualmode()*
|
|
4913 The result is a String, which describes the last Visual mode
|
|
4914 used. Initially it returns an empty string, but once Visual
|
|
4915 mode has been used, it returns "v", "V", or "<CTRL-V>" (a
|
|
4916 single CTRL-V character) for character-wise, line-wise, or
|
|
4917 block-wise Visual mode respectively.
|
|
4918 Example: >
|
|
4919 :exe "normal " . visualmode()
|
|
4920 < This enters the same Visual mode as before. It is also useful
|
|
4921 in scripts if you wish to act differently depending on the
|
|
4922 Visual mode that was used.
|
|
4923
|
|
4924 If an expression is supplied that results in a non-zero number
|
|
4925 or a non-empty string, then the Visual mode will be cleared
|
|
4926 and the old value is returned. Note that " " and "0" are also
|
|
4927 non-empty strings, thus cause the mode to be cleared.
|
|
4928
|
|
4929 *winbufnr()*
|
|
4930 winbufnr({nr}) The result is a Number, which is the number of the buffer
|
236
|
4931 associated with window {nr}. When {nr} is zero, the number of
|
7
|
4932 the buffer in the current window is returned. When window
|
|
4933 {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
4934 Example: >
|
|
4935 :echo "The file in the current window is " . bufname(winbufnr(0))
|
|
4936 <
|
|
4937 *wincol()*
|
|
4938 wincol() The result is a Number, which is the virtual column of the
|
|
4939 cursor in the window. This is counting screen cells from the
|
|
4940 left side of the window. The leftmost column is one.
|
|
4941
|
|
4942 winheight({nr}) *winheight()*
|
|
4943 The result is a Number, which is the height of window {nr}.
|
|
4944 When {nr} is zero, the height of the current window is
|
|
4945 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
4946 An existing window always has a height of zero or more.
|
|
4947 Examples: >
|
|
4948 :echo "The current window has " . winheight(0) . " lines."
|
|
4949 <
|
|
4950 *winline()*
|
|
4951 winline() The result is a Number, which is the screen line of the cursor
|
|
4952 in the window. This is counting screen lines from the top of
|
|
4953 the window. The first line is one.
|
531
|
4954 If the cursor was moved the view on the file will be updated
|
|
4955 first, this may cause a scroll.
|
7
|
4956
|
|
4957 *winnr()*
|
20
|
4958 winnr([{arg}]) The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
|
|
4959 window. The top window has number 1.
|
|
4960 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the
|
674
|
4961 last window is returned (the window count).
|
20
|
4962 When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last
|
|
4963 accessed window is returned (where |CTRL-W_p| goes to).
|
|
4964 If there is no previous window 0 is returned.
|
|
4965 The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
|
|
4966 |:wincmd|.
|
7
|
4967
|
|
4968 *winrestcmd()*
|
|
4969 winrestcmd() Returns a sequence of |:resize| commands that should restore
|
|
4970 the current window sizes. Only works properly when no windows
|
712
|
4971 are opened or closed and the current window and tab page is
|
|
4972 unchanged.
|
7
|
4973 Example: >
|
|
4974 :let cmd = winrestcmd()
|
|
4975 :call MessWithWindowSizes()
|
|
4976 :exe cmd
|
712
|
4977 <
|
|
4978 *winrestview()*
|
|
4979 winrestview({dict})
|
|
4980 Uses the |Dictionary| returned by |winsaveview()| to restore
|
|
4981 the view of the current window.
|
|
4982 If you have changed the values the result is unpredictable.
|
|
4983 If the window size changed the result won't be the same.
|
|
4984
|
|
4985 *winsaveview()*
|
|
4986 winsaveview() Returns a |Dictionary| that contains information to restore
|
|
4987 the view of the current window. Use |winrestview()| to
|
|
4988 restore the view.
|
|
4989 This is useful if you have a mapping that jumps around in the
|
|
4990 buffer and you want to go back to the original view.
|
|
4991 This does not save fold information. Use the 'foldenable'
|
798
|
4992 option to temporarily switch off folding, so that folds are
|
|
4993 not opened when moving around.
|
712
|
4994 The return value includes:
|
|
4995 lnum cursor line number
|
|
4996 col cursor column
|
|
4997 coladd cursor column offset for 'virtualedit'
|
|
4998 curswant column for vertical movement
|
|
4999 topline first line in the window
|
|
5000 topfill filler lines, only in diff mode
|
|
5001 leftcol first column displayed
|
|
5002 skipcol columns skipped
|
|
5003 Note that no option values are saved.
|
|
5004
|
7
|
5005
|
|
5006 winwidth({nr}) *winwidth()*
|
|
5007 The result is a Number, which is the width of window {nr}.
|
|
5008 When {nr} is zero, the width of the current window is
|
|
5009 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
5010 An existing window always has a width of zero or more.
|
|
5011 Examples: >
|
|
5012 :echo "The current window has " . winwidth(0) . " columns."
|
|
5013 :if winwidth(0) <= 50
|
|
5014 : exe "normal 50\<C-W>|"
|
|
5015 :endif
|
|
5016 <
|
158
|
5017 *writefile()*
|
|
5018 writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
|
685
|
5019 Write |List| {list} to file {fname}. Each list item is
|
158
|
5020 separated with a NL. Each list item must be a String or
|
|
5021 Number.
|
|
5022 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used: There will
|
|
5023 not be a NL after the last list item. An empty item at the
|
|
5024 end does cause the last line in the file to end in a NL.
|
|
5025 All NL characters are replaced with a NUL character.
|
|
5026 Inserting CR characters needs to be done before passing {list}
|
|
5027 to writefile().
|
|
5028 An existing file is overwritten, if possible.
|
|
5029 When the write fails -1 is returned, otherwise 0. There is an
|
|
5030 error message if the file can't be created or when writing
|
|
5031 fails.
|
|
5032 Also see |readfile()|.
|
|
5033 To copy a file byte for byte: >
|
|
5034 :let fl = readfile("foo", "b")
|
|
5035 :call writefile(fl, "foocopy", "b")
|
|
5036 <
|
7
|
5037
|
|
5038 *feature-list*
|
|
5039 There are three types of features:
|
|
5040 1. Features that are only supported when they have been enabled when Vim
|
|
5041 was compiled |+feature-list|. Example: >
|
|
5042 :if has("cindent")
|
|
5043 2. Features that are only supported when certain conditions have been met.
|
|
5044 Example: >
|
|
5045 :if has("gui_running")
|
|
5046 < *has-patch*
|
|
5047 3. Included patches. First check |v:version| for the version of Vim.
|
|
5048 Then the "patch123" feature means that patch 123 has been included for
|
|
5049 this version. Example (checking version 6.2.148 or later): >
|
|
5050 :if v:version > 602 || v:version == 602 && has("patch148")
|
|
5051
|
|
5052 all_builtin_terms Compiled with all builtin terminals enabled.
|
|
5053 amiga Amiga version of Vim.
|
|
5054 arabic Compiled with Arabic support |Arabic|.
|
|
5055 arp Compiled with ARP support (Amiga).
|
613
|
5056 autocmd Compiled with autocommand support. |autocommand|
|
7
|
5057 balloon_eval Compiled with |balloon-eval| support.
|
435
|
5058 balloon_multiline GUI supports multiline balloons.
|
7
|
5059 beos BeOS version of Vim.
|
|
5060 browse Compiled with |:browse| support, and browse() will
|
|
5061 work.
|
|
5062 builtin_terms Compiled with some builtin terminals.
|
|
5063 byte_offset Compiled with support for 'o' in 'statusline'
|
|
5064 cindent Compiled with 'cindent' support.
|
|
5065 clientserver Compiled with remote invocation support |clientserver|.
|
|
5066 clipboard Compiled with 'clipboard' support.
|
|
5067 cmdline_compl Compiled with |cmdline-completion| support.
|
|
5068 cmdline_hist Compiled with |cmdline-history| support.
|
|
5069 cmdline_info Compiled with 'showcmd' and 'ruler' support.
|
|
5070 comments Compiled with |'comments'| support.
|
|
5071 cryptv Compiled with encryption support |encryption|.
|
|
5072 cscope Compiled with |cscope| support.
|
|
5073 compatible Compiled to be very Vi compatible.
|
|
5074 debug Compiled with "DEBUG" defined.
|
|
5075 dialog_con Compiled with console dialog support.
|
|
5076 dialog_gui Compiled with GUI dialog support.
|
|
5077 diff Compiled with |vimdiff| and 'diff' support.
|
|
5078 digraphs Compiled with support for digraphs.
|
|
5079 dnd Compiled with support for the "~ register |quote_~|.
|
|
5080 dos32 32 bits DOS (DJGPP) version of Vim.
|
|
5081 dos16 16 bits DOS version of Vim.
|
|
5082 ebcdic Compiled on a machine with ebcdic character set.
|
|
5083 emacs_tags Compiled with support for Emacs tags.
|
|
5084 eval Compiled with expression evaluation support. Always
|
|
5085 true, of course!
|
|
5086 ex_extra Compiled with extra Ex commands |+ex_extra|.
|
|
5087 extra_search Compiled with support for |'incsearch'| and
|
|
5088 |'hlsearch'|
|
|
5089 farsi Compiled with Farsi support |farsi|.
|
|
5090 file_in_path Compiled with support for |gf| and |<cfile>|
|
168
|
5091 filterpipe When 'shelltemp' is off pipes are used for shell
|
|
5092 read/write/filter commands
|
7
|
5093 find_in_path Compiled with support for include file searches
|
|
5094 |+find_in_path|.
|
|
5095 fname_case Case in file names matters (for Amiga, MS-DOS, and
|
|
5096 Windows this is not present).
|
|
5097 folding Compiled with |folding| support.
|
|
5098 footer Compiled with GUI footer support. |gui-footer|
|
|
5099 fork Compiled to use fork()/exec() instead of system().
|
|
5100 gettext Compiled with message translation |multi-lang|
|
|
5101 gui Compiled with GUI enabled.
|
|
5102 gui_athena Compiled with Athena GUI.
|
|
5103 gui_gtk Compiled with GTK+ GUI (any version).
|
|
5104 gui_gtk2 Compiled with GTK+ 2 GUI (gui_gtk is also defined).
|
|
5105 gui_mac Compiled with Macintosh GUI.
|
|
5106 gui_motif Compiled with Motif GUI.
|
|
5107 gui_photon Compiled with Photon GUI.
|
|
5108 gui_win32 Compiled with MS Windows Win32 GUI.
|
|
5109 gui_win32s idem, and Win32s system being used (Windows 3.1)
|
|
5110 gui_running Vim is running in the GUI, or it will start soon.
|
|
5111 hangul_input Compiled with Hangul input support. |hangul|
|
|
5112 iconv Can use iconv() for conversion.
|
|
5113 insert_expand Compiled with support for CTRL-X expansion commands in
|
|
5114 Insert mode.
|
|
5115 jumplist Compiled with |jumplist| support.
|
|
5116 keymap Compiled with 'keymap' support.
|
|
5117 langmap Compiled with 'langmap' support.
|
|
5118 libcall Compiled with |libcall()| support.
|
|
5119 linebreak Compiled with 'linebreak', 'breakat' and 'showbreak'
|
|
5120 support.
|
|
5121 lispindent Compiled with support for lisp indenting.
|
|
5122 listcmds Compiled with commands for the buffer list |:files|
|
|
5123 and the argument list |arglist|.
|
|
5124 localmap Compiled with local mappings and abbr. |:map-local|
|
|
5125 mac Macintosh version of Vim.
|
|
5126 macunix Macintosh version of Vim, using Unix files (OS-X).
|
|
5127 menu Compiled with support for |:menu|.
|
|
5128 mksession Compiled with support for |:mksession|.
|
|
5129 modify_fname Compiled with file name modifiers. |filename-modifiers|
|
|
5130 mouse Compiled with support mouse.
|
|
5131 mouseshape Compiled with support for 'mouseshape'.
|
|
5132 mouse_dec Compiled with support for Dec terminal mouse.
|
|
5133 mouse_gpm Compiled with support for gpm (Linux console mouse)
|
|
5134 mouse_netterm Compiled with support for netterm mouse.
|
|
5135 mouse_pterm Compiled with support for qnx pterm mouse.
|
|
5136 mouse_xterm Compiled with support for xterm mouse.
|
|
5137 multi_byte Compiled with support for editing Korean et al.
|
|
5138 multi_byte_ime Compiled with support for IME input method.
|
|
5139 multi_lang Compiled with support for multiple languages.
|
14
|
5140 mzscheme Compiled with MzScheme interface |mzscheme|.
|
7
|
5141 netbeans_intg Compiled with support for |netbeans|.
|
33
|
5142 netbeans_enabled Compiled with support for |netbeans| and it's used.
|
7
|
5143 ole Compiled with OLE automation support for Win32.
|
|
5144 os2 OS/2 version of Vim.
|
|
5145 osfiletype Compiled with support for osfiletypes |+osfiletype|
|
|
5146 path_extra Compiled with up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags'
|
|
5147 perl Compiled with Perl interface.
|
|
5148 postscript Compiled with PostScript file printing.
|
|
5149 printer Compiled with |:hardcopy| support.
|
170
|
5150 profile Compiled with |:profile| support.
|
7
|
5151 python Compiled with Python interface.
|
|
5152 qnx QNX version of Vim.
|
|
5153 quickfix Compiled with |quickfix| support.
|
|
5154 rightleft Compiled with 'rightleft' support.
|
|
5155 ruby Compiled with Ruby interface |ruby|.
|
|
5156 scrollbind Compiled with 'scrollbind' support.
|
|
5157 showcmd Compiled with 'showcmd' support.
|
|
5158 signs Compiled with |:sign| support.
|
|
5159 smartindent Compiled with 'smartindent' support.
|
9
|
5160 sniff Compiled with SNiFF interface support.
|
7
|
5161 statusline Compiled with support for 'statusline', 'rulerformat'
|
|
5162 and special formats of 'titlestring' and 'iconstring'.
|
|
5163 sun_workshop Compiled with support for Sun |workshop|.
|
314
|
5164 spell Compiled with spell checking support |spell|.
|
|
5165 syntax Compiled with syntax highlighting support |syntax|.
|
7
|
5166 syntax_items There are active syntax highlighting items for the
|
|
5167 current buffer.
|
|
5168 system Compiled to use system() instead of fork()/exec().
|
|
5169 tag_binary Compiled with binary searching in tags files
|
|
5170 |tag-binary-search|.
|
|
5171 tag_old_static Compiled with support for old static tags
|
|
5172 |tag-old-static|.
|
|
5173 tag_any_white Compiled with support for any white characters in tags
|
|
5174 files |tag-any-white|.
|
|
5175 tcl Compiled with Tcl interface.
|
|
5176 terminfo Compiled with terminfo instead of termcap.
|
|
5177 termresponse Compiled with support for |t_RV| and |v:termresponse|.
|
|
5178 textobjects Compiled with support for |text-objects|.
|
|
5179 tgetent Compiled with tgetent support, able to use a termcap
|
|
5180 or terminfo file.
|
|
5181 title Compiled with window title support |'title'|.
|
|
5182 toolbar Compiled with support for |gui-toolbar|.
|
|
5183 unix Unix version of Vim.
|
|
5184 user_commands User-defined commands.
|
|
5185 viminfo Compiled with viminfo support.
|
|
5186 vim_starting True while initial source'ing takes place.
|
|
5187 vertsplit Compiled with vertically split windows |:vsplit|.
|
|
5188 virtualedit Compiled with 'virtualedit' option.
|
|
5189 visual Compiled with Visual mode.
|
|
5190 visualextra Compiled with extra Visual mode commands.
|
|
5191 |blockwise-operators|.
|
|
5192 vms VMS version of Vim.
|
|
5193 vreplace Compiled with |gR| and |gr| commands.
|
|
5194 wildignore Compiled with 'wildignore' option.
|
|
5195 wildmenu Compiled with 'wildmenu' option.
|
|
5196 windows Compiled with support for more than one window.
|
|
5197 winaltkeys Compiled with 'winaltkeys' option.
|
|
5198 win16 Win16 version of Vim (MS-Windows 3.1).
|
|
5199 win32 Win32 version of Vim (MS-Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000/XP).
|
|
5200 win64 Win64 version of Vim (MS-Windows 64 bit).
|
|
5201 win32unix Win32 version of Vim, using Unix files (Cygwin)
|
|
5202 win95 Win32 version for MS-Windows 95/98/ME.
|
|
5203 writebackup Compiled with 'writebackup' default on.
|
|
5204 xfontset Compiled with X fontset support |xfontset|.
|
|
5205 xim Compiled with X input method support |xim|.
|
|
5206 xsmp Compiled with X session management support.
|
|
5207 xsmp_interact Compiled with interactive X session management support.
|
|
5208 xterm_clipboard Compiled with support for xterm clipboard.
|
|
5209 xterm_save Compiled with support for saving and restoring the
|
|
5210 xterm screen.
|
|
5211 x11 Compiled with X11 support.
|
|
5212
|
|
5213 *string-match*
|
|
5214 Matching a pattern in a String
|
|
5215
|
|
5216 A regexp pattern as explained at |pattern| is normally used to find a match in
|
|
5217 the buffer lines. When a pattern is used to find a match in a String, almost
|
|
5218 everything works in the same way. The difference is that a String is handled
|
|
5219 like it is one line. When it contains a "\n" character, this is not seen as a
|
|
5220 line break for the pattern. It can be matched with a "\n" in the pattern, or
|
|
5221 with ".". Example: >
|
|
5222 :let a = "aaaa\nxxxx"
|
|
5223 :echo matchstr(a, "..\n..")
|
|
5224 aa
|
|
5225 xx
|
|
5226 :echo matchstr(a, "a.x")
|
|
5227 a
|
|
5228 x
|
|
5229
|
|
5230 Don't forget that "^" will only match at the first character of the String and
|
|
5231 "$" at the last character of the string. They don't match after or before a
|
|
5232 "\n".
|
|
5233
|
|
5234 ==============================================================================
|
|
5235 5. Defining functions *user-functions*
|
|
5236
|
|
5237 New functions can be defined. These can be called just like builtin
|
|
5238 functions. The function executes a sequence of Ex commands. Normal mode
|
|
5239 commands can be executed with the |:normal| command.
|
|
5240
|
|
5241 The function name must start with an uppercase letter, to avoid confusion with
|
|
5242 builtin functions. To prevent from using the same name in different scripts
|
|
5243 avoid obvious, short names. A good habit is to start the function name with
|
|
5244 the name of the script, e.g., "HTMLcolor()".
|
|
5245
|
504
|
5246 It's also possible to use curly braces, see |curly-braces-names|. And the
|
|
5247 |autoload| facility is useful to define a function only when it's called.
|
7
|
5248
|
|
5249 *local-function*
|
|
5250 A function local to a script must start with "s:". A local script function
|
|
5251 can only be called from within the script and from functions, user commands
|
|
5252 and autocommands defined in the script. It is also possible to call the
|
|
5253 function from a mappings defined in the script, but then |<SID>| must be used
|
|
5254 instead of "s:" when the mapping is expanded outside of the script.
|
|
5255
|
|
5256 *:fu* *:function* *E128* *E129* *E123*
|
|
5257 :fu[nction] List all functions and their arguments.
|
|
5258
|
|
5259 :fu[nction] {name} List function {name}.
|
685
|
5260 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5261 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5262 :function dict.init
|
504
|
5263
|
|
5264 :fu[nction] /{pattern} List functions with a name matching {pattern}.
|
|
5265 Example that lists all functions ending with "File": >
|
|
5266 :function /File$
|
482
|
5267 <
|
|
5268 *:function-verbose*
|
|
5269 When 'verbose' is non-zero, listing a function will also display where it was
|
|
5270 last defined. Example: >
|
|
5271
|
|
5272 :verbose function SetFileTypeSH
|
|
5273 function SetFileTypeSH(name)
|
|
5274 Last set from /usr/share/vim/vim-7.0/filetype.vim
|
|
5275 <
|
484
|
5276 See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
|
482
|
5277
|
|
5278 *E124* *E125*
|
102
|
5279 :fu[nction][!] {name}([arguments]) [range] [abort] [dict]
|
7
|
5280 Define a new function by the name {name}. The name
|
|
5281 must be made of alphanumeric characters and '_', and
|
|
5282 must start with a capital or "s:" (see above).
|
114
|
5283
|
685
|
5284 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5285 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5286 :function dict.init(arg)
|
|
5287 < "dict" must be an existing dictionary. The entry
|
|
5288 "init" is added if it didn't exist yet. Otherwise [!]
|
|
5289 is required to overwrite an existing function. The
|
|
5290 result is a |Funcref| to a numbered function. The
|
|
5291 function can only be used with a |Funcref| and will be
|
|
5292 deleted if there are no more references to it.
|
7
|
5293 *E127* *E122*
|
|
5294 When a function by this name already exists and [!] is
|
|
5295 not used an error message is given. When [!] is used,
|
|
5296 an existing function is silently replaced. Unless it
|
|
5297 is currently being executed, that is an error.
|
133
|
5298
|
|
5299 For the {arguments} see |function-argument|.
|
|
5300
|
7
|
5301 *a:firstline* *a:lastline*
|
|
5302 When the [range] argument is added, the function is
|
|
5303 expected to take care of a range itself. The range is
|
|
5304 passed as "a:firstline" and "a:lastline". If [range]
|
|
5305 is excluded, ":{range}call" will call the function for
|
|
5306 each line in the range, with the cursor on the start
|
|
5307 of each line. See |function-range-example|.
|
114
|
5308
|
7
|
5309 When the [abort] argument is added, the function will
|
|
5310 abort as soon as an error is detected.
|
114
|
5311
|
102
|
5312 When the [dict] argument is added, the function must
|
685
|
5313 be invoked through an entry in a |Dictionary|. The
|
102
|
5314 local variable "self" will then be set to the
|
|
5315 dictionary. See |Dictionary-function|.
|
7
|
5316
|
653
|
5317 The last used search pattern and the redo command "."
|
|
5318 will not be changed by the function.
|
|
5319
|
7
|
5320 *:endf* *:endfunction* *E126* *E193*
|
|
5321 :endf[unction] The end of a function definition. Must be on a line
|
|
5322 by its own, without other commands.
|
|
5323
|
|
5324 *:delf* *:delfunction* *E130* *E131*
|
|
5325 :delf[unction] {name} Delete function {name}.
|
685
|
5326 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5327 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5328 :delfunc dict.init
|
|
5329 < This will remove the "init" entry from "dict". The
|
|
5330 function is deleted if there are no more references to
|
|
5331 it.
|
7
|
5332 *:retu* *:return* *E133*
|
|
5333 :retu[rn] [expr] Return from a function. When "[expr]" is given, it is
|
|
5334 evaluated and returned as the result of the function.
|
|
5335 If "[expr]" is not given, the number 0 is returned.
|
|
5336 When a function ends without an explicit ":return",
|
|
5337 the number 0 is returned.
|
|
5338 Note that there is no check for unreachable lines,
|
|
5339 thus there is no warning if commands follow ":return".
|
|
5340
|
|
5341 If the ":return" is used after a |:try| but before the
|
|
5342 matching |:finally| (if present), the commands
|
|
5343 following the ":finally" up to the matching |:endtry|
|
|
5344 are executed first. This process applies to all
|
|
5345 nested ":try"s inside the function. The function
|
|
5346 returns at the outermost ":endtry".
|
|
5347
|
133
|
5348 *function-argument* *a:var*
|
|
5349 An argument can be defined by giving its name. In the function this can then
|
|
5350 be used as "a:name" ("a:" for argument).
|
|
5351 *a:0* *a:1* *a:000* *E740*
|
|
5352 Up to 20 arguments can be given, separated by commas. After the named
|
|
5353 arguments an argument "..." can be specified, which means that more arguments
|
|
5354 may optionally be following. In the function the extra arguments can be used
|
|
5355 as "a:1", "a:2", etc. "a:0" is set to the number of extra arguments (which
|
685
|
5356 can be 0). "a:000" is set to a |List| that contains these arguments. Note
|
|
5357 that "a:1" is the same as "a:000[0]".
|
148
|
5358 *E742*
|
|
5359 The a: scope and the variables in it cannot be changed, they are fixed.
|
685
|
5360 However, if a |List| or |Dictionary| is used, you can changes their contents.
|
|
5361 Thus you can pass a |List| to a function and have the function add an item to
|
|
5362 it. If you want to make sure the function cannot change a |List| or
|
|
5363 |Dictionary| use |:lockvar|.
|
133
|
5364
|
|
5365 When not using "...", the number of arguments in a function call must be equal
|
|
5366 to the number of named arguments. When using "...", the number of arguments
|
|
5367 may be larger.
|
|
5368
|
|
5369 It is also possible to define a function without any arguments. You must
|
|
5370 still supply the () then. The body of the function follows in the next lines,
|
|
5371 until the matching |:endfunction|. It is allowed to define another function
|
|
5372 inside a function body.
|
|
5373
|
|
5374 *local-variables*
|
7
|
5375 Inside a function variables can be used. These are local variables, which
|
|
5376 will disappear when the function returns. Global variables need to be
|
|
5377 accessed with "g:".
|
|
5378
|
|
5379 Example: >
|
|
5380 :function Table(title, ...)
|
|
5381 : echohl Title
|
|
5382 : echo a:title
|
|
5383 : echohl None
|
140
|
5384 : echo a:0 . " items:"
|
|
5385 : for s in a:000
|
|
5386 : echon ' ' . s
|
|
5387 : endfor
|
7
|
5388 :endfunction
|
|
5389
|
|
5390 This function can then be called with: >
|
140
|
5391 call Table("Table", "line1", "line2")
|
|
5392 call Table("Empty Table")
|
7
|
5393
|
|
5394 To return more than one value, pass the name of a global variable: >
|
|
5395 :function Compute(n1, n2, divname)
|
|
5396 : if a:n2 == 0
|
|
5397 : return "fail"
|
|
5398 : endif
|
|
5399 : let g:{a:divname} = a:n1 / a:n2
|
|
5400 : return "ok"
|
|
5401 :endfunction
|
|
5402
|
|
5403 This function can then be called with: >
|
|
5404 :let success = Compute(13, 1324, "div")
|
|
5405 :if success == "ok"
|
|
5406 : echo div
|
|
5407 :endif
|
|
5408
|
|
5409 An alternative is to return a command that can be executed. This also works
|
|
5410 with local variables in a calling function. Example: >
|
|
5411 :function Foo()
|
|
5412 : execute Bar()
|
|
5413 : echo "line " . lnum . " column " . col
|
|
5414 :endfunction
|
|
5415
|
|
5416 :function Bar()
|
|
5417 : return "let lnum = " . line(".") . " | let col = " . col(".")
|
|
5418 :endfunction
|
|
5419
|
|
5420 The names "lnum" and "col" could also be passed as argument to Bar(), to allow
|
|
5421 the caller to set the names.
|
|
5422
|
786
|
5423 *:cal* *:call* *E107* *E117*
|
7
|
5424 :[range]cal[l] {name}([arguments])
|
|
5425 Call a function. The name of the function and its arguments
|
|
5426 are as specified with |:function|. Up to 20 arguments can be
|
|
5427 used.
|
|
5428 Without a range and for functions that accept a range, the
|
|
5429 function is called once. When a range is given the cursor is
|
|
5430 positioned at the start of the first line before executing the
|
|
5431 function.
|
|
5432 When a range is given and the function doesn't handle it
|
|
5433 itself, the function is executed for each line in the range,
|
|
5434 with the cursor in the first column of that line. The cursor
|
|
5435 is left at the last line (possibly moved by the last function
|
|
5436 call). The arguments are re-evaluated for each line. Thus
|
|
5437 this works:
|
|
5438 *function-range-example* >
|
|
5439 :function Mynumber(arg)
|
|
5440 : echo line(".") . " " . a:arg
|
|
5441 :endfunction
|
|
5442 :1,5call Mynumber(getline("."))
|
|
5443 <
|
|
5444 The "a:firstline" and "a:lastline" are defined anyway, they
|
|
5445 can be used to do something different at the start or end of
|
|
5446 the range.
|
|
5447
|
|
5448 Example of a function that handles the range itself: >
|
|
5449
|
|
5450 :function Cont() range
|
|
5451 : execute (a:firstline + 1) . "," . a:lastline . 's/^/\t\\ '
|
|
5452 :endfunction
|
|
5453 :4,8call Cont()
|
|
5454 <
|
|
5455 This function inserts the continuation character "\" in front
|
|
5456 of all the lines in the range, except the first one.
|
|
5457
|
|
5458 *E132*
|
|
5459 The recursiveness of user functions is restricted with the |'maxfuncdepth'|
|
|
5460 option.
|
|
5461
|
161
|
5462
|
|
5463 AUTOMATICALLY LOADING FUNCTIONS ~
|
7
|
5464 *autoload-functions*
|
|
5465 When using many or large functions, it's possible to automatically define them
|
161
|
5466 only when they are used. There are two methods: with an autocommand and with
|
|
5467 the "autoload" directory in 'runtimepath'.
|
|
5468
|
|
5469
|
|
5470 Using an autocommand ~
|
|
5471
|
170
|
5472 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.14|.
|
|
5473
|
161
|
5474 The autocommand is useful if you have a plugin that is a long Vim script file.
|
|
5475 You can define the autocommand and quickly quit the script with |:finish|.
|
|
5476 That makes Vim startup faster. The autocommand should then load the same file
|
|
5477 again, setting a variable to skip the |:finish| command.
|
|
5478
|
|
5479 Use the FuncUndefined autocommand event with a pattern that matches the
|
|
5480 function(s) to be defined. Example: >
|
7
|
5481
|
|
5482 :au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim
|
|
5483
|
|
5484 The file "~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim" should then define functions that start with
|
|
5485 "BufNet". Also see |FuncUndefined|.
|
|
5486
|
161
|
5487
|
|
5488 Using an autoload script ~
|
168
|
5489 *autoload* *E746*
|
170
|
5490 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.15|.
|
|
5491
|
161
|
5492 Using a script in the "autoload" directory is simpler, but requires using
|
|
5493 exactly the right file name. A function that can be autoloaded has a name
|
|
5494 like this: >
|
|
5495
|
270
|
5496 :call filename#funcname()
|
161
|
5497
|
|
5498 When such a function is called, and it is not defined yet, Vim will search the
|
|
5499 "autoload" directories in 'runtimepath' for a script file called
|
|
5500 "filename.vim". For example "~/.vim/autoload/filename.vim". That file should
|
|
5501 then define the function like this: >
|
|
5502
|
270
|
5503 function filename#funcname()
|
161
|
5504 echo "Done!"
|
|
5505 endfunction
|
|
5506
|
530
|
5507 The file name and the name used before the # in the function must match
|
161
|
5508 exactly, and the defined function must have the name exactly as it will be
|
|
5509 called.
|
|
5510
|
270
|
5511 It is possible to use subdirectories. Every # in the function name works like
|
|
5512 a path separator. Thus when calling a function: >
|
|
5513
|
|
5514 :call foo#bar#func()
|
161
|
5515
|
|
5516 Vim will look for the file "autoload/foo/bar.vim" in 'runtimepath'.
|
|
5517
|
168
|
5518 This also works when reading a variable that has not been set yet: >
|
|
5519
|
270
|
5520 :let l = foo#bar#lvar
|
168
|
5521
|
557
|
5522 However, when the autoload script was already loaded it won't be loaded again
|
|
5523 for an unknown variable.
|
|
5524
|
168
|
5525 When assigning a value to such a variable nothing special happens. This can
|
|
5526 be used to pass settings to the autoload script before it's loaded: >
|
|
5527
|
270
|
5528 :let foo#bar#toggle = 1
|
|
5529 :call foo#bar#func()
|
168
|
5530
|
164
|
5531 Note that when you make a mistake and call a function that is supposed to be
|
|
5532 defined in an autoload script, but the script doesn't actually define the
|
|
5533 function, the script will be sourced every time you try to call the function.
|
168
|
5534 And you will get an error message every time.
|
|
5535
|
|
5536 Also note that if you have two script files, and one calls a function in the
|
|
5537 other and vise versa, before the used function is defined, it won't work.
|
|
5538 Avoid using the autoload functionality at the toplevel.
|
161
|
5539
|
794
|
5540 Hint: If you distribute a bunch of scripts you can pack them together with the
|
|
5541 |vimball| utility. Also read the user manual |distribute-script|.
|
|
5542
|
7
|
5543 ==============================================================================
|
|
5544 6. Curly braces names *curly-braces-names*
|
|
5545
|
|
5546 Wherever you can use a variable, you can use a "curly braces name" variable.
|
|
5547 This is a regular variable name with one or more expressions wrapped in braces
|
|
5548 {} like this: >
|
|
5549 my_{adjective}_variable
|
|
5550
|
|
5551 When Vim encounters this, it evaluates the expression inside the braces, puts
|
|
5552 that in place of the expression, and re-interprets the whole as a variable
|
|
5553 name. So in the above example, if the variable "adjective" was set to
|
|
5554 "noisy", then the reference would be to "my_noisy_variable", whereas if
|
|
5555 "adjective" was set to "quiet", then it would be to "my_quiet_variable".
|
|
5556
|
|
5557 One application for this is to create a set of variables governed by an option
|
|
5558 value. For example, the statement >
|
|
5559 echo my_{&background}_message
|
|
5560
|
|
5561 would output the contents of "my_dark_message" or "my_light_message" depending
|
|
5562 on the current value of 'background'.
|
|
5563
|
|
5564 You can use multiple brace pairs: >
|
|
5565 echo my_{adverb}_{adjective}_message
|
|
5566 ..or even nest them: >
|
|
5567 echo my_{ad{end_of_word}}_message
|
|
5568 where "end_of_word" is either "verb" or "jective".
|
|
5569
|
|
5570 However, the expression inside the braces must evaluate to a valid single
|
236
|
5571 variable name, e.g. this is invalid: >
|
7
|
5572 :let foo='a + b'
|
|
5573 :echo c{foo}d
|
|
5574 .. since the result of expansion is "ca + bd", which is not a variable name.
|
|
5575
|
|
5576 *curly-braces-function-names*
|
|
5577 You can call and define functions by an evaluated name in a similar way.
|
|
5578 Example: >
|
|
5579 :let func_end='whizz'
|
|
5580 :call my_func_{func_end}(parameter)
|
|
5581
|
|
5582 This would call the function "my_func_whizz(parameter)".
|
|
5583
|
|
5584 ==============================================================================
|
|
5585 7. Commands *expression-commands*
|
|
5586
|
|
5587 :let {var-name} = {expr1} *:let* *E18*
|
|
5588 Set internal variable {var-name} to the result of the
|
|
5589 expression {expr1}. The variable will get the type
|
|
5590 from the {expr}. If {var-name} didn't exist yet, it
|
|
5591 is created.
|
|
5592
|
85
|
5593 :let {var-name}[{idx}] = {expr1} *E689*
|
|
5594 Set a list item to the result of the expression
|
|
5595 {expr1}. {var-name} must refer to a list and {idx}
|
|
5596 must be a valid index in that list. For nested list
|
|
5597 the index can be repeated.
|
|
5598 This cannot be used to add an item to a list.
|
|
5599
|
114
|
5600 *E711* *E719*
|
|
5601 :let {var-name}[{idx1}:{idx2}] = {expr1} *E708* *E709* *E710*
|
685
|
5602 Set a sequence of items in a |List| to the result of
|
|
5603 the expression {expr1}, which must be a list with the
|
87
|
5604 correct number of items.
|
|
5605 {idx1} can be omitted, zero is used instead.
|
|
5606 {idx2} can be omitted, meaning the end of the list.
|
|
5607 When the selected range of items is partly past the
|
|
5608 end of the list, items will be added.
|
|
5609
|
153
|
5610 *:let+=* *:let-=* *:let.=* *E734*
|
114
|
5611 :let {var} += {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} + {expr1}".
|
|
5612 :let {var} -= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} - {expr1}".
|
|
5613 :let {var} .= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} . {expr1}".
|
|
5614 These fail if {var} was not set yet and when the type
|
|
5615 of {var} and {expr1} don't fit the operator.
|
|
5616
|
|
5617
|
7
|
5618 :let ${env-name} = {expr1} *:let-environment* *:let-$*
|
|
5619 Set environment variable {env-name} to the result of
|
|
5620 the expression {expr1}. The type is always String.
|
114
|
5621 :let ${env-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5622 Append {expr1} to the environment variable {env-name}.
|
|
5623 If the environment variable didn't exist yet this
|
|
5624 works like "=".
|
7
|
5625
|
|
5626 :let @{reg-name} = {expr1} *:let-register* *:let-@*
|
|
5627 Write the result of the expression {expr1} in register
|
|
5628 {reg-name}. {reg-name} must be a single letter, and
|
|
5629 must be the name of a writable register (see
|
|
5630 |registers|). "@@" can be used for the unnamed
|
|
5631 register, "@/" for the search pattern.
|
|
5632 If the result of {expr1} ends in a <CR> or <NL>, the
|
|
5633 register will be linewise, otherwise it will be set to
|
|
5634 characterwise.
|
|
5635 This can be used to clear the last search pattern: >
|
|
5636 :let @/ = ""
|
|
5637 < This is different from searching for an empty string,
|
|
5638 that would match everywhere.
|
|
5639
|
114
|
5640 :let @{reg-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5641 Append {expr1} to register {reg-name}. If the
|
|
5642 register was empty it's like setting it to {expr1}.
|
|
5643
|
7
|
5644 :let &{option-name} = {expr1} *:let-option* *:let-star*
|
|
5645 Set option {option-name} to the result of the
|
68
|
5646 expression {expr1}. A String or Number value is
|
|
5647 always converted to the type of the option.
|
7
|
5648 For an option local to a window or buffer the effect
|
|
5649 is just like using the |:set| command: both the local
|
555
|
5650 value and the global value are changed.
|
68
|
5651 Example: >
|
|
5652 :let &path = &path . ',/usr/local/include'
|
7
|
5653
|
114
|
5654 :let &{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5655 For a string option: Append {expr1} to the value.
|
|
5656 Does not insert a comma like |:set+=|.
|
|
5657
|
|
5658 :let &{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5659 :let &{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
|
5660 For a number or boolean option: Add or subtract
|
|
5661 {expr1}.
|
|
5662
|
7
|
5663 :let &l:{option-name} = {expr1}
|
114
|
5664 :let &l:{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5665 :let &l:{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5666 :let &l:{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
7
|
5667 Like above, but only set the local value of an option
|
|
5668 (if there is one). Works like |:setlocal|.
|
|
5669
|
|
5670 :let &g:{option-name} = {expr1}
|
114
|
5671 :let &g:{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5672 :let &g:{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5673 :let &g:{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
7
|
5674 Like above, but only set the global value of an option
|
|
5675 (if there is one). Works like |:setglobal|.
|
|
5676
|
85
|
5677 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] = {expr1} *:let-unpack* *E687* *E688*
|
685
|
5678 {expr1} must evaluate to a |List|. The first item in
|
68
|
5679 the list is assigned to {name1}, the second item to
|
|
5680 {name2}, etc.
|
|
5681 The number of names must match the number of items in
|
685
|
5682 the |List|.
|
68
|
5683 Each name can be one of the items of the ":let"
|
|
5684 command as mentioned above.
|
|
5685 Example: >
|
|
5686 :let [s, item] = GetItem(s)
|
114
|
5687 < Detail: {expr1} is evaluated first, then the
|
|
5688 assignments are done in sequence. This matters if
|
|
5689 {name2} depends on {name1}. Example: >
|
|
5690 :let x = [0, 1]
|
|
5691 :let i = 0
|
|
5692 :let [i, x[i]] = [1, 2]
|
|
5693 :echo x
|
|
5694 < The result is [0, 2].
|
|
5695
|
|
5696 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] .= {expr1}
|
|
5697 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] += {expr1}
|
|
5698 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] -= {expr1}
|
|
5699 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
|
685
|
5700 |List| item.
|
68
|
5701
|
|
5702 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] = {expr1}
|
685
|
5703 Like |:let-unpack| above, but the |List| may have more
|
114
|
5704 items than there are names. A list of the remaining
|
|
5705 items is assigned to {lastname}. If there are no
|
|
5706 remaining items {lastname} is set to an empty list.
|
68
|
5707 Example: >
|
|
5708 :let [a, b; rest] = ["aval", "bval", 3, 4]
|
|
5709 <
|
114
|
5710 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] .= {expr1}
|
|
5711 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] += {expr1}
|
|
5712 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] -= {expr1}
|
|
5713 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
|
685
|
5714 |List| item.
|
7
|
5715 *E106*
|
114
|
5716 :let {var-name} .. List the value of variable {var-name}. Multiple
|
123
|
5717 variable names may be given. Special names recognized
|
|
5718 here: *E738*
|
777
|
5719 g: global variables
|
|
5720 b: local buffer variables
|
|
5721 w: local window variables
|
819
|
5722 t: local tab page variables
|
777
|
5723 s: script-local variables
|
|
5724 l: local function variables
|
123
|
5725 v: Vim variables.
|
7
|
5726
|
55
|
5727 :let List the values of all variables. The type of the
|
|
5728 variable is indicated before the value:
|
|
5729 <nothing> String
|
|
5730 # Number
|
|
5731 * Funcref
|
7
|
5732
|
148
|
5733
|
|
5734 :unl[et][!] {name} ... *:unlet* *:unl* *E108*
|
|
5735 Remove the internal variable {name}. Several variable
|
|
5736 names can be given, they are all removed. The name
|
685
|
5737 may also be a |List| or |Dictionary| item.
|
7
|
5738 With [!] no error message is given for non-existing
|
|
5739 variables.
|
685
|
5740 One or more items from a |List| can be removed: >
|
108
|
5741 :unlet list[3] " remove fourth item
|
|
5742 :unlet list[3:] " remove fourth item to last
|
685
|
5743 < One item from a |Dictionary| can be removed at a time: >
|
108
|
5744 :unlet dict['two']
|
|
5745 :unlet dict.two
|
7
|
5746
|
148
|
5747 :lockv[ar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:lockvar* *:lockv*
|
|
5748 Lock the internal variable {name}. Locking means that
|
|
5749 it can no longer be changed (until it is unlocked).
|
|
5750 A locked variable can be deleted: >
|
|
5751 :lockvar v
|
|
5752 :let v = 'asdf' " fails!
|
|
5753 :unlet v
|
|
5754 < *E741*
|
|
5755 If you try to change a locked variable you get an
|
|
5756 error message: "E741: Value of {name} is locked"
|
|
5757
|
685
|
5758 [depth] is relevant when locking a |List| or
|
|
5759 |Dictionary|. It specifies how deep the locking goes:
|
|
5760 1 Lock the |List| or |Dictionary| itself,
|
148
|
5761 cannot add or remove items, but can
|
|
5762 still change their values.
|
|
5763 2 Also lock the values, cannot change
|
685
|
5764 the items. If an item is a |List| or
|
|
5765 |Dictionary|, cannot add or remove
|
148
|
5766 items, but can still change the
|
|
5767 values.
|
685
|
5768 3 Like 2 but for the |List| /
|
|
5769 |Dictionary| in the |List| /
|
|
5770 |Dictionary|, one level deeper.
|
|
5771 The default [depth] is 2, thus when {name} is a |List|
|
|
5772 or |Dictionary| the values cannot be changed.
|
148
|
5773 *E743*
|
|
5774 For unlimited depth use [!] and omit [depth].
|
|
5775 However, there is a maximum depth of 100 to catch
|
|
5776 loops.
|
|
5777
|
685
|
5778 Note that when two variables refer to the same |List|
|
|
5779 and you lock one of them, the |List| will also be
|
819
|
5780 locked when used through the other variable.
|
|
5781 Example: >
|
148
|
5782 :let l = [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
|
5783 :let cl = l
|
|
5784 :lockvar l
|
|
5785 :let cl[1] = 99 " won't work!
|
|
5786 < You may want to make a copy of a list to avoid this.
|
|
5787 See |deepcopy()|.
|
|
5788
|
|
5789
|
|
5790 :unlo[ckvar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:unlockvar* *:unlo*
|
|
5791 Unlock the internal variable {name}. Does the
|
|
5792 opposite of |:lockvar|.
|
|
5793
|
|
5794
|
7
|
5795 :if {expr1} *:if* *:endif* *:en* *E171* *E579* *E580*
|
|
5796 :en[dif] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
|
|
5797 or ":endif" if {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
|
|
5798
|
|
5799 From Vim version 4.5 until 5.0, every Ex command in
|
|
5800 between the ":if" and ":endif" is ignored. These two
|
|
5801 commands were just to allow for future expansions in a
|
|
5802 backwards compatible way. Nesting was allowed. Note
|
|
5803 that any ":else" or ":elseif" was ignored, the "else"
|
|
5804 part was not executed either.
|
|
5805
|
|
5806 You can use this to remain compatible with older
|
|
5807 versions: >
|
|
5808 :if version >= 500
|
|
5809 : version-5-specific-commands
|
|
5810 :endif
|
|
5811 < The commands still need to be parsed to find the
|
|
5812 "endif". Sometimes an older Vim has a problem with a
|
|
5813 new command. For example, ":silent" is recognized as
|
|
5814 a ":substitute" command. In that case ":execute" can
|
|
5815 avoid problems: >
|
|
5816 :if version >= 600
|
|
5817 : execute "silent 1,$delete"
|
|
5818 :endif
|
|
5819 <
|
|
5820 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
|
|
5821 properly in between ":if" and ":endif".
|
|
5822
|
|
5823 *:else* *:el* *E581* *E583*
|
|
5824 :el[se] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
|
|
5825 or ":endif" if they previously were not being
|
|
5826 executed.
|
|
5827
|
|
5828 *:elseif* *:elsei* *E582* *E584*
|
|
5829 :elsei[f] {expr1} Short for ":else" ":if", with the addition that there
|
|
5830 is no extra ":endif".
|
|
5831
|
|
5832 :wh[ile] {expr1} *:while* *:endwhile* *:wh* *:endw*
|
114
|
5833 *E170* *E585* *E588* *E733*
|
7
|
5834 :endw[hile] Repeat the commands between ":while" and ":endwhile",
|
|
5835 as long as {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
|
|
5836 When an error is detected from a command inside the
|
|
5837 loop, execution continues after the "endwhile".
|
75
|
5838 Example: >
|
|
5839 :let lnum = 1
|
|
5840 :while lnum <= line("$")
|
|
5841 :call FixLine(lnum)
|
|
5842 :let lnum = lnum + 1
|
|
5843 :endwhile
|
|
5844 <
|
7
|
5845 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
|
99
|
5846 properly inside a ":while" and ":for" loop.
|
75
|
5847
|
114
|
5848 :for {var} in {list} *:for* *E690* *E732*
|
75
|
5849 :endfo[r] *:endfo* *:endfor*
|
|
5850 Repeat the commands between ":for" and ":endfor" for
|
158
|
5851 each item in {list}. Variable {var} is set to the
|
79
|
5852 value of each item.
|
|
5853 When an error is detected for a command inside the
|
75
|
5854 loop, execution continues after the "endfor".
|
464
|
5855 Changing {list} inside the loop affects what items are
|
|
5856 used. Make a copy if this is unwanted: >
|
79
|
5857 :for item in copy(mylist)
|
|
5858 < When not making a copy, Vim stores a reference to the
|
|
5859 next item in the list, before executing the commands
|
|
5860 with the current item. Thus the current item can be
|
|
5861 removed without effect. Removing any later item means
|
|
5862 it will not be found. Thus the following example
|
|
5863 works (an inefficient way to make a list empty): >
|
|
5864 :for item in mylist
|
75
|
5865 :call remove(mylist, 0)
|
|
5866 :endfor
|
87
|
5867 < Note that reordering the list (e.g., with sort() or
|
|
5868 reverse()) may have unexpected effects.
|
|
5869 Note that the type of each list item should be
|
75
|
5870 identical to avoid errors for the type of {var}
|
|
5871 changing. Unlet the variable at the end of the loop
|
|
5872 to allow multiple item types.
|
|
5873
|
|
5874 :for [{var1}, {var2}, ...] in {listlist}
|
|
5875 :endfo[r]
|
|
5876 Like ":for" above, but each item in {listlist} must be
|
|
5877 a list, of which each item is assigned to {var1},
|
|
5878 {var2}, etc. Example: >
|
|
5879 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 5], [3, 8]]
|
|
5880 :echo getline(lnum)[col]
|
|
5881 :endfor
|
|
5882 <
|
7
|
5883 *:continue* *:con* *E586*
|
75
|
5884 :con[tinue] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, jumps back
|
|
5885 to the start of the loop.
|
|
5886 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
|
|
5887 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
|
|
5888 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
|
|
5889 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
|
|
5890 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
|
|
5891 ":endtry" then jumps back to the start of the loop.
|
7
|
5892
|
|
5893 *:break* *:brea* *E587*
|
75
|
5894 :brea[k] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, skips to
|
|
5895 the command after the matching ":endwhile" or
|
|
5896 ":endfor".
|
|
5897 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
|
|
5898 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
|
|
5899 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
|
|
5900 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
|
|
5901 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
|
|
5902 ":endtry" then jumps to the command after the loop.
|
7
|
5903
|
|
5904 :try *:try* *:endt* *:endtry* *E600* *E601* *E602*
|
|
5905 :endt[ry] Change the error handling for the commands between
|
|
5906 ":try" and ":endtry" including everything being
|
|
5907 executed across ":source" commands, function calls,
|
|
5908 or autocommand invocations.
|
|
5909
|
|
5910 When an error or interrupt is detected and there is
|
|
5911 a |:finally| command following, execution continues
|
|
5912 after the ":finally". Otherwise, or when the
|
|
5913 ":endtry" is reached thereafter, the next
|
|
5914 (dynamically) surrounding ":try" is checked for
|
|
5915 a corresponding ":finally" etc. Then the script
|
|
5916 processing is terminated. (Whether a function
|
|
5917 definition has an "abort" argument does not matter.)
|
|
5918 Example: >
|
|
5919 :try | edit too much | finally | echo "cleanup" | endtry
|
|
5920 :echo "impossible" " not reached, script terminated above
|
|
5921 <
|
|
5922 Moreover, an error or interrupt (dynamically) inside
|
|
5923 ":try" and ":endtry" is converted to an exception. It
|
|
5924 can be caught as if it were thrown by a |:throw|
|
|
5925 command (see |:catch|). In this case, the script
|
|
5926 processing is not terminated.
|
|
5927
|
|
5928 The value "Vim:Interrupt" is used for an interrupt
|
|
5929 exception. An error in a Vim command is converted
|
|
5930 to a value of the form "Vim({command}):{errmsg}",
|
|
5931 other errors are converted to a value of the form
|
|
5932 "Vim:{errmsg}". {command} is the full command name,
|
|
5933 and {errmsg} is the message that is displayed if the
|
|
5934 error exception is not caught, always beginning with
|
|
5935 the error number.
|
|
5936 Examples: >
|
|
5937 :try | sleep 100 | catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | endtry
|
|
5938 :try | edit | catch /^Vim(edit):E\d\+/ | echo "error" | endtry
|
|
5939 <
|
|
5940 *:cat* *:catch* *E603* *E604* *E605*
|
|
5941 :cat[ch] /{pattern}/ The following commands until the next ":catch",
|
|
5942 |:finally|, or |:endtry| that belongs to the same
|
|
5943 |:try| as the ":catch" are executed when an exception
|
|
5944 matching {pattern} is being thrown and has not yet
|
|
5945 been caught by a previous ":catch". Otherwise, these
|
|
5946 commands are skipped.
|
|
5947 When {pattern} is omitted all errors are caught.
|
|
5948 Examples: >
|
|
5949 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ " catch interrupts (CTRL-C)
|
|
5950 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E/ " catch all Vim errors
|
|
5951 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:/ " catch errors and interrupts
|
|
5952 :catch /^Vim(write):/ " catch all errors in :write
|
|
5953 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E123/ " catch error E123
|
|
5954 :catch /my-exception/ " catch user exception
|
|
5955 :catch /.*/ " catch everything
|
|
5956 :catch " same as /.*/
|
|
5957 <
|
|
5958 Another character can be used instead of / around the
|
|
5959 {pattern}, so long as it does not have a special
|
|
5960 meaning (e.g., '|' or '"') and doesn't occur inside
|
|
5961 {pattern}.
|
|
5962 NOTE: It is not reliable to ":catch" the TEXT of
|
|
5963 an error message because it may vary in different
|
|
5964 locales.
|
|
5965
|
|
5966 *:fina* *:finally* *E606* *E607*
|
|
5967 :fina[lly] The following commands until the matching |:endtry|
|
|
5968 are executed whenever the part between the matching
|
|
5969 |:try| and the ":finally" is left: either by falling
|
|
5970 through to the ":finally" or by a |:continue|,
|
|
5971 |:break|, |:finish|, or |:return|, or by an error or
|
|
5972 interrupt or exception (see |:throw|).
|
|
5973
|
|
5974 *:th* *:throw* *E608*
|
|
5975 :th[row] {expr1} The {expr1} is evaluated and thrown as an exception.
|
|
5976 If the ":throw" is used after a |:try| but before the
|
|
5977 first corresponding |:catch|, commands are skipped
|
|
5978 until the first ":catch" matching {expr1} is reached.
|
|
5979 If there is no such ":catch" or if the ":throw" is
|
|
5980 used after a ":catch" but before the |:finally|, the
|
|
5981 commands following the ":finally" (if present) up to
|
|
5982 the matching |:endtry| are executed. If the ":throw"
|
|
5983 is after the ":finally", commands up to the ":endtry"
|
|
5984 are skipped. At the ":endtry", this process applies
|
|
5985 again for the next dynamically surrounding ":try"
|
|
5986 (which may be found in a calling function or sourcing
|
|
5987 script), until a matching ":catch" has been found.
|
|
5988 If the exception is not caught, the command processing
|
|
5989 is terminated.
|
|
5990 Example: >
|
|
5991 :try | throw "oops" | catch /^oo/ | echo "caught" | endtry
|
|
5992 <
|
|
5993
|
|
5994 *:ec* *:echo*
|
|
5995 :ec[ho] {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, with a space in between. The
|
|
5996 first {expr1} starts on a new line.
|
|
5997 Also see |:comment|.
|
|
5998 Use "\n" to start a new line. Use "\r" to move the
|
|
5999 cursor to the first column.
|
|
6000 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6001 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6002 Example: >
|
|
6003 :echo "the value of 'shell' is" &shell
|
|
6004 < A later redraw may make the message disappear again.
|
|
6005 To avoid that a command from before the ":echo" causes
|
|
6006 a redraw afterwards (redraws are often postponed until
|
|
6007 you type something), force a redraw with the |:redraw|
|
|
6008 command. Example: >
|
|
6009 :new | redraw | echo "there is a new window"
|
|
6010 <
|
|
6011 *:echon*
|
|
6012 :echon {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, without anything added. Also see
|
|
6013 |:comment|.
|
|
6014 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6015 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6016 Example: >
|
|
6017 :echon "the value of 'shell' is " &shell
|
|
6018 <
|
|
6019 Note the difference between using ":echo", which is a
|
|
6020 Vim command, and ":!echo", which is an external shell
|
|
6021 command: >
|
|
6022 :!echo % --> filename
|
|
6023 < The arguments of ":!" are expanded, see |:_%|. >
|
|
6024 :!echo "%" --> filename or "filename"
|
|
6025 < Like the previous example. Whether you see the double
|
|
6026 quotes or not depends on your 'shell'. >
|
|
6027 :echo % --> nothing
|
|
6028 < The '%' is an illegal character in an expression. >
|
|
6029 :echo "%" --> %
|
|
6030 < This just echoes the '%' character. >
|
|
6031 :echo expand("%") --> filename
|
|
6032 < This calls the expand() function to expand the '%'.
|
|
6033
|
|
6034 *:echoh* *:echohl*
|
|
6035 :echoh[l] {name} Use the highlight group {name} for the following
|
|
6036 |:echo|, |:echon| and |:echomsg| commands. Also used
|
|
6037 for the |input()| prompt. Example: >
|
|
6038 :echohl WarningMsg | echo "Don't panic!" | echohl None
|
|
6039 < Don't forget to set the group back to "None",
|
|
6040 otherwise all following echo's will be highlighted.
|
|
6041
|
|
6042 *:echom* *:echomsg*
|
|
6043 :echom[sg] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as a true message, saving the
|
|
6044 message in the |message-history|.
|
|
6045 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
|
|
6046 |:echo| command. But unprintable characters are
|
|
6047 displayed, not interpreted.
|
|
6048 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6049 Example: >
|
|
6050 :echomsg "It's a Zizzer Zazzer Zuzz, as you can plainly see."
|
|
6051 <
|
|
6052 *:echoe* *:echoerr*
|
|
6053 :echoe[rr] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as an error message, saving the
|
|
6054 message in the |message-history|. When used in a
|
|
6055 script or function the line number will be added.
|
|
6056 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
|
|
6057 :echo command. When used inside a try conditional,
|
|
6058 the message is raised as an error exception instead
|
|
6059 (see |try-echoerr|).
|
|
6060 Example: >
|
|
6061 :echoerr "This script just failed!"
|
|
6062 < If you just want a highlighted message use |:echohl|.
|
|
6063 And to get a beep: >
|
|
6064 :exe "normal \<Esc>"
|
|
6065 <
|
|
6066 *:exe* *:execute*
|
|
6067 :exe[cute] {expr1} .. Executes the string that results from the evaluation
|
|
6068 of {expr1} as an Ex command. Multiple arguments are
|
|
6069 concatenated, with a space in between. {expr1} is
|
|
6070 used as the processed command, command line editing
|
|
6071 keys are not recognized.
|
|
6072 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6073 Examples: >
|
|
6074 :execute "buffer " nextbuf
|
|
6075 :execute "normal " count . "w"
|
|
6076 <
|
|
6077 ":execute" can be used to append a command to commands
|
|
6078 that don't accept a '|'. Example: >
|
|
6079 :execute '!ls' | echo "theend"
|
|
6080
|
|
6081 < ":execute" is also a nice way to avoid having to type
|
|
6082 control characters in a Vim script for a ":normal"
|
|
6083 command: >
|
|
6084 :execute "normal ixxx\<Esc>"
|
|
6085 < This has an <Esc> character, see |expr-string|.
|
|
6086
|
|
6087 Note: The executed string may be any command-line, but
|
99
|
6088 you cannot start or end a "while", "for" or "if"
|
|
6089 command. Thus this is illegal: >
|
7
|
6090 :execute 'while i > 5'
|
|
6091 :execute 'echo "test" | break'
|
|
6092 <
|
|
6093 It is allowed to have a "while" or "if" command
|
|
6094 completely in the executed string: >
|
|
6095 :execute 'while i < 5 | echo i | let i = i + 1 | endwhile'
|
|
6096 <
|
|
6097
|
|
6098 *:comment*
|
|
6099 ":execute", ":echo" and ":echon" cannot be followed by
|
|
6100 a comment directly, because they see the '"' as the
|
|
6101 start of a string. But, you can use '|' followed by a
|
|
6102 comment. Example: >
|
|
6103 :echo "foo" | "this is a comment
|
|
6104
|
|
6105 ==============================================================================
|
|
6106 8. Exception handling *exception-handling*
|
|
6107
|
|
6108 The Vim script language comprises an exception handling feature. This section
|
|
6109 explains how it can be used in a Vim script.
|
|
6110
|
|
6111 Exceptions may be raised by Vim on an error or on interrupt, see
|
|
6112 |catch-errors| and |catch-interrupt|. You can also explicitly throw an
|
|
6113 exception by using the ":throw" command, see |throw-catch|.
|
|
6114
|
|
6115
|
|
6116 TRY CONDITIONALS *try-conditionals*
|
|
6117
|
|
6118 Exceptions can be caught or can cause cleanup code to be executed. You can
|
|
6119 use a try conditional to specify catch clauses (that catch exceptions) and/or
|
|
6120 a finally clause (to be executed for cleanup).
|
|
6121 A try conditional begins with a |:try| command and ends at the matching
|
|
6122 |:endtry| command. In between, you can use a |:catch| command to start
|
|
6123 a catch clause, or a |:finally| command to start a finally clause. There may
|
|
6124 be none or multiple catch clauses, but there is at most one finally clause,
|
|
6125 which must not be followed by any catch clauses. The lines before the catch
|
|
6126 clauses and the finally clause is called a try block. >
|
|
6127
|
|
6128 :try
|
|
6129 : ...
|
|
6130 : ... TRY BLOCK
|
|
6131 : ...
|
|
6132 :catch /{pattern}/
|
|
6133 : ...
|
|
6134 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
|
|
6135 : ...
|
|
6136 :catch /{pattern}/
|
|
6137 : ...
|
|
6138 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
|
|
6139 : ...
|
|
6140 :finally
|
|
6141 : ...
|
|
6142 : ... FINALLY CLAUSE
|
|
6143 : ...
|
|
6144 :endtry
|
|
6145
|
|
6146 The try conditional allows to watch code for exceptions and to take the
|
|
6147 appropriate actions. Exceptions from the try block may be caught. Exceptions
|
|
6148 from the try block and also the catch clauses may cause cleanup actions.
|
|
6149 When no exception is thrown during execution of the try block, the control
|
|
6150 is transferred to the finally clause, if present. After its execution, the
|
|
6151 script continues with the line following the ":endtry".
|
|
6152 When an exception occurs during execution of the try block, the remaining
|
|
6153 lines in the try block are skipped. The exception is matched against the
|
|
6154 patterns specified as arguments to the ":catch" commands. The catch clause
|
|
6155 after the first matching ":catch" is taken, other catch clauses are not
|
|
6156 executed. The catch clause ends when the next ":catch", ":finally", or
|
|
6157 ":endtry" command is reached - whatever is first. Then, the finally clause
|
|
6158 (if present) is executed. When the ":endtry" is reached, the script execution
|
|
6159 continues in the following line as usual.
|
|
6160 When an exception that does not match any of the patterns specified by the
|
|
6161 ":catch" commands is thrown in the try block, the exception is not caught by
|
|
6162 that try conditional and none of the catch clauses is executed. Only the
|
|
6163 finally clause, if present, is taken. The exception pends during execution of
|
|
6164 the finally clause. It is resumed at the ":endtry", so that commands after
|
|
6165 the ":endtry" are not executed and the exception might be caught elsewhere,
|
|
6166 see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6167 When during execution of a catch clause another exception is thrown, the
|
|
6168 remaining lines in that catch clause are not executed. The new exception is
|
|
6169 not matched against the patterns in any of the ":catch" commands of the same
|
|
6170 try conditional and none of its catch clauses is taken. If there is, however,
|
|
6171 a finally clause, it is executed, and the exception pends during its
|
|
6172 execution. The commands following the ":endtry" are not executed. The new
|
|
6173 exception might, however, be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6174 When during execution of the finally clause (if present) an exception is
|
|
6175 thrown, the remaining lines in the finally clause are skipped. If the finally
|
|
6176 clause has been taken because of an exception from the try block or one of the
|
|
6177 catch clauses, the original (pending) exception is discarded. The commands
|
|
6178 following the ":endtry" are not executed, and the exception from the finally
|
|
6179 clause is propagated and can be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6180
|
|
6181 The finally clause is also executed, when a ":break" or ":continue" for
|
|
6182 a ":while" loop enclosing the complete try conditional is executed from the
|
|
6183 try block or a catch clause. Or when a ":return" or ":finish" is executed
|
|
6184 from the try block or a catch clause of a try conditional in a function or
|
|
6185 sourced script, respectively. The ":break", ":continue", ":return", or
|
|
6186 ":finish" pends during execution of the finally clause and is resumed when the
|
|
6187 ":endtry" is reached. It is, however, discarded when an exception is thrown
|
|
6188 from the finally clause.
|
|
6189 When a ":break" or ":continue" for a ":while" loop enclosing the complete
|
|
6190 try conditional or when a ":return" or ":finish" is encountered in the finally
|
|
6191 clause, the rest of the finally clause is skipped, and the ":break",
|
|
6192 ":continue", ":return" or ":finish" is executed as usual. If the finally
|
|
6193 clause has been taken because of an exception or an earlier ":break",
|
|
6194 ":continue", ":return", or ":finish" from the try block or a catch clause,
|
|
6195 this pending exception or command is discarded.
|
|
6196
|
|
6197 For examples see |throw-catch| and |try-finally|.
|
|
6198
|
|
6199
|
|
6200 NESTING OF TRY CONDITIONALS *try-nesting*
|
|
6201
|
|
6202 Try conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. That is, a complete try
|
|
6203 conditional can be put into the try block, a catch clause, or the finally
|
|
6204 clause of another try conditional. If the inner try conditional does not
|
|
6205 catch an exception thrown in its try block or throws a new exception from one
|
|
6206 of its catch clauses or its finally clause, the outer try conditional is
|
|
6207 checked according to the rules above. If the inner try conditional is in the
|
|
6208 try block of the outer try conditional, its catch clauses are checked, but
|
|
6209 otherwise only the finally clause is executed. It does not matter for
|
|
6210 nesting, whether the inner try conditional is directly contained in the outer
|
|
6211 one, or whether the outer one sources a script or calls a function containing
|
|
6212 the inner try conditional.
|
|
6213
|
|
6214 When none of the active try conditionals catches an exception, just their
|
|
6215 finally clauses are executed. Thereafter, the script processing terminates.
|
|
6216 An error message is displayed in case of an uncaught exception explicitly
|
|
6217 thrown by a ":throw" command. For uncaught error and interrupt exceptions
|
|
6218 implicitly raised by Vim, the error message(s) or interrupt message are shown
|
|
6219 as usual.
|
|
6220
|
|
6221 For examples see |throw-catch|.
|
|
6222
|
|
6223
|
|
6224 EXAMINING EXCEPTION HANDLING CODE *except-examine*
|
|
6225
|
|
6226 Exception handling code can get tricky. If you are in doubt what happens, set
|
|
6227 'verbose' to 13 or use the ":13verbose" command modifier when sourcing your
|
|
6228 script file. Then you see when an exception is thrown, discarded, caught, or
|
|
6229 finished. When using a verbosity level of at least 14, things pending in
|
|
6230 a finally clause are also shown. This information is also given in debug mode
|
|
6231 (see |debug-scripts|).
|
|
6232
|
|
6233
|
|
6234 THROWING AND CATCHING EXCEPTIONS *throw-catch*
|
|
6235
|
|
6236 You can throw any number or string as an exception. Use the |:throw| command
|
|
6237 and pass the value to be thrown as argument: >
|
|
6238 :throw 4711
|
|
6239 :throw "string"
|
|
6240 < *throw-expression*
|
|
6241 You can also specify an expression argument. The expression is then evaluated
|
|
6242 first, and the result is thrown: >
|
|
6243 :throw 4705 + strlen("string")
|
|
6244 :throw strpart("strings", 0, 6)
|
|
6245
|
|
6246 An exception might be thrown during evaluation of the argument of the ":throw"
|
|
6247 command. Unless it is caught there, the expression evaluation is abandoned.
|
|
6248 The ":throw" command then does not throw a new exception.
|
|
6249 Example: >
|
|
6250
|
|
6251 :function! Foo(arg)
|
|
6252 : try
|
|
6253 : throw a:arg
|
|
6254 : catch /foo/
|
|
6255 : endtry
|
|
6256 : return 1
|
|
6257 :endfunction
|
|
6258 :
|
|
6259 :function! Bar()
|
|
6260 : echo "in Bar"
|
|
6261 : return 4710
|
|
6262 :endfunction
|
|
6263 :
|
|
6264 :throw Foo("arrgh") + Bar()
|
|
6265
|
|
6266 This throws "arrgh", and "in Bar" is not displayed since Bar() is not
|
|
6267 executed. >
|
|
6268 :throw Foo("foo") + Bar()
|
|
6269 however displays "in Bar" and throws 4711.
|
|
6270
|
|
6271 Any other command that takes an expression as argument might also be
|
|
6272 abandoned by an (uncaught) exception during the expression evaluation. The
|
|
6273 exception is then propagated to the caller of the command.
|
|
6274 Example: >
|
|
6275
|
|
6276 :if Foo("arrgh")
|
|
6277 : echo "then"
|
|
6278 :else
|
|
6279 : echo "else"
|
|
6280 :endif
|
|
6281
|
|
6282 Here neither of "then" or "else" is displayed.
|
|
6283
|
|
6284 *catch-order*
|
|
6285 Exceptions can be caught by a try conditional with one or more |:catch|
|
|
6286 commands, see |try-conditionals|. The values to be caught by each ":catch"
|
|
6287 command can be specified as a pattern argument. The subsequent catch clause
|
|
6288 gets executed when a matching exception is caught.
|
|
6289 Example: >
|
|
6290
|
|
6291 :function! Foo(value)
|
|
6292 : try
|
|
6293 : throw a:value
|
|
6294 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6295 : echo "Number thrown"
|
|
6296 : catch /.*/
|
|
6297 : echo "String thrown"
|
|
6298 : endtry
|
|
6299 :endfunction
|
|
6300 :
|
|
6301 :call Foo(0x1267)
|
|
6302 :call Foo('string')
|
|
6303
|
|
6304 The first call to Foo() displays "Number thrown", the second "String thrown".
|
|
6305 An exception is matched against the ":catch" commands in the order they are
|
|
6306 specified. Only the first match counts. So you should place the more
|
|
6307 specific ":catch" first. The following order does not make sense: >
|
|
6308
|
|
6309 : catch /.*/
|
|
6310 : echo "String thrown"
|
|
6311 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6312 : echo "Number thrown"
|
|
6313
|
|
6314 The first ":catch" here matches always, so that the second catch clause is
|
|
6315 never taken.
|
|
6316
|
|
6317 *throw-variables*
|
|
6318 If you catch an exception by a general pattern, you may access the exact value
|
|
6319 in the variable |v:exception|: >
|
|
6320
|
|
6321 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6322 : echo "Number thrown. Value is" v:exception
|
|
6323
|
|
6324 You may also be interested where an exception was thrown. This is stored in
|
|
6325 |v:throwpoint|. Note that "v:exception" and "v:throwpoint" are valid for the
|
|
6326 exception most recently caught as long it is not finished.
|
|
6327 Example: >
|
|
6328
|
|
6329 :function! Caught()
|
|
6330 : if v:exception != ""
|
|
6331 : echo 'Caught "' . v:exception . '" in ' . v:throwpoint
|
|
6332 : else
|
|
6333 : echo 'Nothing caught'
|
|
6334 : endif
|
|
6335 :endfunction
|
|
6336 :
|
|
6337 :function! Foo()
|
|
6338 : try
|
|
6339 : try
|
|
6340 : try
|
|
6341 : throw 4711
|
|
6342 : finally
|
|
6343 : call Caught()
|
|
6344 : endtry
|
|
6345 : catch /.*/
|
|
6346 : call Caught()
|
|
6347 : throw "oops"
|
|
6348 : endtry
|
|
6349 : catch /.*/
|
|
6350 : call Caught()
|
|
6351 : finally
|
|
6352 : call Caught()
|
|
6353 : endtry
|
|
6354 :endfunction
|
|
6355 :
|
|
6356 :call Foo()
|
|
6357
|
|
6358 This displays >
|
|
6359
|
|
6360 Nothing caught
|
|
6361 Caught "4711" in function Foo, line 4
|
|
6362 Caught "oops" in function Foo, line 10
|
|
6363 Nothing caught
|
|
6364
|
|
6365 A practical example: The following command ":LineNumber" displays the line
|
|
6366 number in the script or function where it has been used: >
|
|
6367
|
|
6368 :function! LineNumber()
|
|
6369 : return substitute(v:throwpoint, '.*\D\(\d\+\).*', '\1', "")
|
|
6370 :endfunction
|
|
6371 :command! LineNumber try | throw "" | catch | echo LineNumber() | endtry
|
|
6372 <
|
|
6373 *try-nested*
|
|
6374 An exception that is not caught by a try conditional can be caught by
|
|
6375 a surrounding try conditional: >
|
|
6376
|
|
6377 :try
|
|
6378 : try
|
|
6379 : throw "foo"
|
|
6380 : catch /foobar/
|
|
6381 : echo "foobar"
|
|
6382 : finally
|
|
6383 : echo "inner finally"
|
|
6384 : endtry
|
|
6385 :catch /foo/
|
|
6386 : echo "foo"
|
|
6387 :endtry
|
|
6388
|
|
6389 The inner try conditional does not catch the exception, just its finally
|
|
6390 clause is executed. The exception is then caught by the outer try
|
|
6391 conditional. The example displays "inner finally" and then "foo".
|
|
6392
|
|
6393 *throw-from-catch*
|
|
6394 You can catch an exception and throw a new one to be caught elsewhere from the
|
|
6395 catch clause: >
|
|
6396
|
|
6397 :function! Foo()
|
|
6398 : throw "foo"
|
|
6399 :endfunction
|
|
6400 :
|
|
6401 :function! Bar()
|
|
6402 : try
|
|
6403 : call Foo()
|
|
6404 : catch /foo/
|
|
6405 : echo "Caught foo, throw bar"
|
|
6406 : throw "bar"
|
|
6407 : endtry
|
|
6408 :endfunction
|
|
6409 :
|
|
6410 :try
|
|
6411 : call Bar()
|
|
6412 :catch /.*/
|
|
6413 : echo "Caught" v:exception
|
|
6414 :endtry
|
|
6415
|
|
6416 This displays "Caught foo, throw bar" and then "Caught bar".
|
|
6417
|
|
6418 *rethrow*
|
|
6419 There is no real rethrow in the Vim script language, but you may throw
|
|
6420 "v:exception" instead: >
|
|
6421
|
|
6422 :function! Bar()
|
|
6423 : try
|
|
6424 : call Foo()
|
|
6425 : catch /.*/
|
|
6426 : echo "Rethrow" v:exception
|
|
6427 : throw v:exception
|
|
6428 : endtry
|
|
6429 :endfunction
|
|
6430 < *try-echoerr*
|
|
6431 Note that this method cannot be used to "rethrow" Vim error or interrupt
|
|
6432 exceptions, because it is not possible to fake Vim internal exceptions.
|
|
6433 Trying so causes an error exception. You should throw your own exception
|
|
6434 denoting the situation. If you want to cause a Vim error exception containing
|
|
6435 the original error exception value, you can use the |:echoerr| command: >
|
|
6436
|
|
6437 :try
|
|
6438 : try
|
|
6439 : asdf
|
|
6440 : catch /.*/
|
|
6441 : echoerr v:exception
|
|
6442 : endtry
|
|
6443 :catch /.*/
|
|
6444 : echo v:exception
|
|
6445 :endtry
|
|
6446
|
|
6447 This code displays
|
|
6448
|
|
6449 Vim(echoerr):Vim:E492: Not an editor command: asdf ~
|
|
6450
|
|
6451
|
|
6452 CLEANUP CODE *try-finally*
|
|
6453
|
|
6454 Scripts often change global settings and restore them at their end. If the
|
|
6455 user however interrupts the script by pressing CTRL-C, the settings remain in
|
|
6456 an inconsistent state. The same may happen to you in the development phase of
|
|
6457 a script when an error occurs or you explicitly throw an exception without
|
|
6458 catching it. You can solve these problems by using a try conditional with
|
|
6459 a finally clause for restoring the settings. Its execution is guaranteed on
|
|
6460 normal control flow, on error, on an explicit ":throw", and on interrupt.
|
|
6461 (Note that errors and interrupts from inside the try conditional are converted
|
|
6462 to exceptions. When not caught, they terminate the script after the finally
|
|
6463 clause has been executed.)
|
|
6464 Example: >
|
|
6465
|
|
6466 :try
|
|
6467 : let s:saved_ts = &ts
|
|
6468 : set ts=17
|
|
6469 :
|
|
6470 : " Do the hard work here.
|
|
6471 :
|
|
6472 :finally
|
|
6473 : let &ts = s:saved_ts
|
|
6474 : unlet s:saved_ts
|
|
6475 :endtry
|
|
6476
|
|
6477 This method should be used locally whenever a function or part of a script
|
|
6478 changes global settings which need to be restored on failure or normal exit of
|
|
6479 that function or script part.
|
|
6480
|
|
6481 *break-finally*
|
|
6482 Cleanup code works also when the try block or a catch clause is left by
|
|
6483 a ":continue", ":break", ":return", or ":finish".
|
|
6484 Example: >
|
|
6485
|
|
6486 :let first = 1
|
|
6487 :while 1
|
|
6488 : try
|
|
6489 : if first
|
|
6490 : echo "first"
|
|
6491 : let first = 0
|
|
6492 : continue
|
|
6493 : else
|
|
6494 : throw "second"
|
|
6495 : endif
|
|
6496 : catch /.*/
|
|
6497 : echo v:exception
|
|
6498 : break
|
|
6499 : finally
|
|
6500 : echo "cleanup"
|
|
6501 : endtry
|
|
6502 : echo "still in while"
|
|
6503 :endwhile
|
|
6504 :echo "end"
|
|
6505
|
|
6506 This displays "first", "cleanup", "second", "cleanup", and "end". >
|
|
6507
|
|
6508 :function! Foo()
|
|
6509 : try
|
|
6510 : return 4711
|
|
6511 : finally
|
|
6512 : echo "cleanup\n"
|
|
6513 : endtry
|
|
6514 : echo "Foo still active"
|
|
6515 :endfunction
|
|
6516 :
|
|
6517 :echo Foo() "returned by Foo"
|
|
6518
|
|
6519 This displays "cleanup" and "4711 returned by Foo". You don't need to add an
|
|
6520 extra ":return" in the finally clause. (Above all, this would override the
|
|
6521 return value.)
|
|
6522
|
|
6523 *except-from-finally*
|
|
6524 Using either of ":continue", ":break", ":return", ":finish", or ":throw" in
|
|
6525 a finally clause is possible, but not recommended since it abandons the
|
|
6526 cleanup actions for the try conditional. But, of course, interrupt and error
|
|
6527 exceptions might get raised from a finally clause.
|
|
6528 Example where an error in the finally clause stops an interrupt from
|
|
6529 working correctly: >
|
|
6530
|
|
6531 :try
|
|
6532 : try
|
|
6533 : echo "Press CTRL-C for interrupt"
|
|
6534 : while 1
|
|
6535 : endwhile
|
|
6536 : finally
|
|
6537 : unlet novar
|
|
6538 : endtry
|
|
6539 :catch /novar/
|
|
6540 :endtry
|
|
6541 :echo "Script still running"
|
|
6542 :sleep 1
|
|
6543
|
|
6544 If you need to put commands that could fail into a finally clause, you should
|
|
6545 think about catching or ignoring the errors in these commands, see
|
|
6546 |catch-errors| and |ignore-errors|.
|
|
6547
|
|
6548
|
|
6549 CATCHING ERRORS *catch-errors*
|
|
6550
|
|
6551 If you want to catch specific errors, you just have to put the code to be
|
|
6552 watched in a try block and add a catch clause for the error message. The
|
|
6553 presence of the try conditional causes all errors to be converted to an
|
|
6554 exception. No message is displayed and |v:errmsg| is not set then. To find
|
|
6555 the right pattern for the ":catch" command, you have to know how the format of
|
|
6556 the error exception is.
|
|
6557 Error exceptions have the following format: >
|
|
6558
|
|
6559 Vim({cmdname}):{errmsg}
|
|
6560 or >
|
|
6561 Vim:{errmsg}
|
|
6562
|
|
6563 {cmdname} is the name of the command that failed; the second form is used when
|
|
6564 the command name is not known. {errmsg} is the error message usually produced
|
|
6565 when the error occurs outside try conditionals. It always begins with
|
|
6566 a capital "E", followed by a two or three-digit error number, a colon, and
|
|
6567 a space.
|
|
6568
|
|
6569 Examples:
|
|
6570
|
|
6571 The command >
|
|
6572 :unlet novar
|
|
6573 normally produces the error message >
|
|
6574 E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
6575 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6576 Vim(unlet):E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
6577
|
|
6578 The command >
|
|
6579 :dwim
|
|
6580 normally produces the error message >
|
|
6581 E492: Not an editor command: dwim
|
|
6582 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6583 Vim:E492: Not an editor command: dwim
|
|
6584
|
|
6585 You can catch all ":unlet" errors by a >
|
|
6586 :catch /^Vim(unlet):/
|
|
6587 or all errors for misspelled command names by a >
|
|
6588 :catch /^Vim:E492:/
|
|
6589
|
|
6590 Some error messages may be produced by different commands: >
|
|
6591 :function nofunc
|
|
6592 and >
|
|
6593 :delfunction nofunc
|
|
6594 both produce the error message >
|
|
6595 E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6596 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6597 Vim(function):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6598 or >
|
|
6599 Vim(delfunction):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6600 respectively. You can catch the error by its number independently on the
|
|
6601 command that caused it if you use the following pattern: >
|
|
6602 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E128:/
|
|
6603
|
|
6604 Some commands like >
|
|
6605 :let x = novar
|
|
6606 produce multiple error messages, here: >
|
|
6607 E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
6608 E15: Invalid expression: novar
|
|
6609 Only the first is used for the exception value, since it is the most specific
|
|
6610 one (see |except-several-errors|). So you can catch it by >
|
|
6611 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E121:/
|
|
6612
|
|
6613 You can catch all errors related to the name "nofunc" by >
|
|
6614 :catch /\<nofunc\>/
|
|
6615
|
|
6616 You can catch all Vim errors in the ":write" and ":read" commands by >
|
|
6617 :catch /^Vim(\(write\|read\)):E\d\+:/
|
|
6618
|
|
6619 You can catch all Vim errors by the pattern >
|
|
6620 :catch /^Vim\((\a\+)\)\=:E\d\+:/
|
|
6621 <
|
|
6622 *catch-text*
|
|
6623 NOTE: You should never catch the error message text itself: >
|
|
6624 :catch /No such variable/
|
|
6625 only works in the english locale, but not when the user has selected
|
|
6626 a different language by the |:language| command. It is however helpful to
|
|
6627 cite the message text in a comment: >
|
|
6628 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E108:/ " No such variable
|
|
6629
|
|
6630
|
|
6631 IGNORING ERRORS *ignore-errors*
|
|
6632
|
|
6633 You can ignore errors in a specific Vim command by catching them locally: >
|
|
6634
|
|
6635 :try
|
|
6636 : write
|
|
6637 :catch
|
|
6638 :endtry
|
|
6639
|
|
6640 But you are strongly recommended NOT to use this simple form, since it could
|
|
6641 catch more than you want. With the ":write" command, some autocommands could
|
|
6642 be executed and cause errors not related to writing, for instance: >
|
|
6643
|
|
6644 :au BufWritePre * unlet novar
|
|
6645
|
|
6646 There could even be such errors you are not responsible for as a script
|
|
6647 writer: a user of your script might have defined such autocommands. You would
|
|
6648 then hide the error from the user.
|
|
6649 It is much better to use >
|
|
6650
|
|
6651 :try
|
|
6652 : write
|
|
6653 :catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
6654 :endtry
|
|
6655
|
|
6656 which only catches real write errors. So catch only what you'd like to ignore
|
|
6657 intentionally.
|
|
6658
|
|
6659 For a single command that does not cause execution of autocommands, you could
|
|
6660 even suppress the conversion of errors to exceptions by the ":silent!"
|
|
6661 command: >
|
|
6662 :silent! nunmap k
|
|
6663 This works also when a try conditional is active.
|
|
6664
|
|
6665
|
|
6666 CATCHING INTERRUPTS *catch-interrupt*
|
|
6667
|
|
6668 When there are active try conditionals, an interrupt (CTRL-C) is converted to
|
|
6669 the exception "Vim:Interrupt". You can catch it like every exception. The
|
|
6670 script is not terminated, then.
|
|
6671 Example: >
|
|
6672
|
|
6673 :function! TASK1()
|
|
6674 : sleep 10
|
|
6675 :endfunction
|
|
6676
|
|
6677 :function! TASK2()
|
|
6678 : sleep 20
|
|
6679 :endfunction
|
|
6680
|
|
6681 :while 1
|
|
6682 : let command = input("Type a command: ")
|
|
6683 : try
|
|
6684 : if command == ""
|
|
6685 : continue
|
|
6686 : elseif command == "END"
|
|
6687 : break
|
|
6688 : elseif command == "TASK1"
|
|
6689 : call TASK1()
|
|
6690 : elseif command == "TASK2"
|
|
6691 : call TASK2()
|
|
6692 : else
|
|
6693 : echo "\nIllegal command:" command
|
|
6694 : continue
|
|
6695 : endif
|
|
6696 : catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
|
|
6697 : echo "\nCommand interrupted"
|
|
6698 : " Caught the interrupt. Continue with next prompt.
|
|
6699 : endtry
|
|
6700 :endwhile
|
|
6701
|
|
6702 You can interrupt a task here by pressing CTRL-C; the script then asks for
|
|
6703 a new command. If you press CTRL-C at the prompt, the script is terminated.
|
|
6704
|
|
6705 For testing what happens when CTRL-C would be pressed on a specific line in
|
|
6706 your script, use the debug mode and execute the |>quit| or |>interrupt|
|
|
6707 command on that line. See |debug-scripts|.
|
|
6708
|
|
6709
|
|
6710 CATCHING ALL *catch-all*
|
|
6711
|
|
6712 The commands >
|
|
6713
|
|
6714 :catch /.*/
|
|
6715 :catch //
|
|
6716 :catch
|
|
6717
|
|
6718 catch everything, error exceptions, interrupt exceptions and exceptions
|
|
6719 explicitly thrown by the |:throw| command. This is useful at the top level of
|
|
6720 a script in order to catch unexpected things.
|
|
6721 Example: >
|
|
6722
|
|
6723 :try
|
|
6724 :
|
|
6725 : " do the hard work here
|
|
6726 :
|
|
6727 :catch /MyException/
|
|
6728 :
|
|
6729 : " handle known problem
|
|
6730 :
|
|
6731 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
|
|
6732 : echo "Script interrupted"
|
|
6733 :catch /.*/
|
|
6734 : echo "Internal error (" . v:exception . ")"
|
|
6735 : echo " - occurred at " . v:throwpoint
|
|
6736 :endtry
|
|
6737 :" end of script
|
|
6738
|
|
6739 Note: Catching all might catch more things than you want. Thus, you are
|
|
6740 strongly encouraged to catch only for problems that you can really handle by
|
|
6741 specifying a pattern argument to the ":catch".
|
|
6742 Example: Catching all could make it nearly impossible to interrupt a script
|
|
6743 by pressing CTRL-C: >
|
|
6744
|
|
6745 :while 1
|
|
6746 : try
|
|
6747 : sleep 1
|
|
6748 : catch
|
|
6749 : endtry
|
|
6750 :endwhile
|
|
6751
|
|
6752
|
|
6753 EXCEPTIONS AND AUTOCOMMANDS *except-autocmd*
|
|
6754
|
|
6755 Exceptions may be used during execution of autocommands. Example: >
|
|
6756
|
|
6757 :autocmd User x try
|
|
6758 :autocmd User x throw "Oops!"
|
|
6759 :autocmd User x catch
|
|
6760 :autocmd User x echo v:exception
|
|
6761 :autocmd User x endtry
|
|
6762 :autocmd User x throw "Arrgh!"
|
|
6763 :autocmd User x echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6764 :
|
|
6765 :try
|
|
6766 : doautocmd User x
|
|
6767 :catch
|
|
6768 : echo v:exception
|
|
6769 :endtry
|
|
6770
|
|
6771 This displays "Oops!" and "Arrgh!".
|
|
6772
|
|
6773 *except-autocmd-Pre*
|
|
6774 For some commands, autocommands get executed before the main action of the
|
|
6775 command takes place. If an exception is thrown and not caught in the sequence
|
|
6776 of autocommands, the sequence and the command that caused its execution are
|
|
6777 abandoned and the exception is propagated to the caller of the command.
|
|
6778 Example: >
|
|
6779
|
|
6780 :autocmd BufWritePre * throw "FAIL"
|
|
6781 :autocmd BufWritePre * echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6782 :
|
|
6783 :try
|
|
6784 : write
|
|
6785 :catch
|
|
6786 : echo "Caught:" v:exception "from" v:throwpoint
|
|
6787 :endtry
|
|
6788
|
|
6789 Here, the ":write" command does not write the file currently being edited (as
|
|
6790 you can see by checking 'modified'), since the exception from the BufWritePre
|
|
6791 autocommand abandons the ":write". The exception is then caught and the
|
|
6792 script displays: >
|
|
6793
|
|
6794 Caught: FAIL from BufWrite Auto commands for "*"
|
|
6795 <
|
|
6796 *except-autocmd-Post*
|
|
6797 For some commands, autocommands get executed after the main action of the
|
|
6798 command has taken place. If this main action fails and the command is inside
|
|
6799 an active try conditional, the autocommands are skipped and an error exception
|
|
6800 is thrown that can be caught by the caller of the command.
|
|
6801 Example: >
|
|
6802
|
|
6803 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "File successfully written!"
|
|
6804 :
|
|
6805 :try
|
|
6806 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6807 :catch
|
|
6808 : echo v:exception
|
|
6809 :endtry
|
|
6810
|
|
6811 This just displays: >
|
|
6812
|
|
6813 Vim(write):E212: Can't open file for writing (/i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e)
|
|
6814
|
|
6815 If you really need to execute the autocommands even when the main action
|
|
6816 fails, trigger the event from the catch clause.
|
|
6817 Example: >
|
|
6818
|
|
6819 :autocmd BufWritePre * set noreadonly
|
|
6820 :autocmd BufWritePost * set readonly
|
|
6821 :
|
|
6822 :try
|
|
6823 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6824 :catch
|
|
6825 : doautocmd BufWritePost /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6826 :endtry
|
|
6827 <
|
|
6828 You can also use ":silent!": >
|
|
6829
|
|
6830 :let x = "ok"
|
|
6831 :let v:errmsg = ""
|
|
6832 :autocmd BufWritePost * if v:errmsg != ""
|
|
6833 :autocmd BufWritePost * let x = "after fail"
|
|
6834 :autocmd BufWritePost * endif
|
|
6835 :try
|
|
6836 : silent! write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6837 :catch
|
|
6838 :endtry
|
|
6839 :echo x
|
|
6840
|
|
6841 This displays "after fail".
|
|
6842
|
|
6843 If the main action of the command does not fail, exceptions from the
|
|
6844 autocommands will be catchable by the caller of the command: >
|
|
6845
|
|
6846 :autocmd BufWritePost * throw ":-("
|
|
6847 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6848 :
|
|
6849 :try
|
|
6850 : write
|
|
6851 :catch
|
|
6852 : echo v:exception
|
|
6853 :endtry
|
|
6854 <
|
|
6855 *except-autocmd-Cmd*
|
|
6856 For some commands, the normal action can be replaced by a sequence of
|
|
6857 autocommands. Exceptions from that sequence will be catchable by the caller
|
|
6858 of the command.
|
|
6859 Example: For the ":write" command, the caller cannot know whether the file
|
|
6860 had actually been written when the exception occurred. You need to tell it in
|
|
6861 some way. >
|
|
6862
|
|
6863 :if !exists("cnt")
|
|
6864 : let cnt = 0
|
|
6865 :
|
|
6866 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if &modified
|
|
6867 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * let cnt = cnt + 1
|
|
6868 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 2
|
|
6869 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
|
|
6870 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6871 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * write | set nomodified
|
|
6872 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 0
|
|
6873 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
|
|
6874 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6875 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * echo "File successfully written!"
|
|
6876 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6877 :endif
|
|
6878 :
|
|
6879 :try
|
|
6880 : write
|
|
6881 :catch /^BufWriteCmdError$/
|
|
6882 : if &modified
|
|
6883 : echo "Error on writing (file contents not changed)"
|
|
6884 : else
|
|
6885 : echo "Error after writing"
|
|
6886 : endif
|
|
6887 :catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
6888 : echo "Error on writing"
|
|
6889 :endtry
|
|
6890
|
|
6891 When this script is sourced several times after making changes, it displays
|
|
6892 first >
|
|
6893 File successfully written!
|
|
6894 then >
|
|
6895 Error on writing (file contents not changed)
|
|
6896 then >
|
|
6897 Error after writing
|
|
6898 etc.
|
|
6899
|
|
6900 *except-autocmd-ill*
|
|
6901 You cannot spread a try conditional over autocommands for different events.
|
|
6902 The following code is ill-formed: >
|
|
6903
|
|
6904 :autocmd BufWritePre * try
|
|
6905 :
|
|
6906 :autocmd BufWritePost * catch
|
|
6907 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo v:exception
|
|
6908 :autocmd BufWritePost * endtry
|
|
6909 :
|
|
6910 :write
|
|
6911
|
|
6912
|
|
6913 EXCEPTION HIERARCHIES AND PARAMETERIZED EXCEPTIONS *except-hier-param*
|
|
6914
|
|
6915 Some programming languages allow to use hierarchies of exception classes or to
|
|
6916 pass additional information with the object of an exception class. You can do
|
|
6917 similar things in Vim.
|
|
6918 In order to throw an exception from a hierarchy, just throw the complete
|
|
6919 class name with the components separated by a colon, for instance throw the
|
|
6920 string "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW" for an overflow in a mathematical library.
|
|
6921 When you want to pass additional information with your exception class, add
|
|
6922 it in parentheses, for instance throw the string "EXCEPT:IO:WRITEERR(myfile)"
|
|
6923 for an error when writing "myfile".
|
|
6924 With the appropriate patterns in the ":catch" command, you can catch for
|
|
6925 base classes or derived classes of your hierarchy. Additional information in
|
|
6926 parentheses can be cut out from |v:exception| with the ":substitute" command.
|
|
6927 Example: >
|
|
6928
|
|
6929 :function! CheckRange(a, func)
|
|
6930 : if a:a < 0
|
|
6931 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE(" . a:func . ")"
|
|
6932 : endif
|
|
6933 :endfunction
|
|
6934 :
|
|
6935 :function! Add(a, b)
|
|
6936 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Add")
|
|
6937 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Add")
|
|
6938 : let c = a:a + a:b
|
|
6939 : if c < 0
|
|
6940 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW"
|
|
6941 : endif
|
|
6942 : return c
|
|
6943 :endfunction
|
|
6944 :
|
|
6945 :function! Div(a, b)
|
|
6946 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Div")
|
|
6947 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Div")
|
|
6948 : if (a:b == 0)
|
|
6949 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:ZERODIV"
|
|
6950 : endif
|
|
6951 : return a:a / a:b
|
|
6952 :endfunction
|
|
6953 :
|
|
6954 :function! Write(file)
|
|
6955 : try
|
|
6956 : execute "write" a:file
|
|
6957 : catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
6958 : throw "EXCEPT:IO(" . getcwd() . ", " . a:file . "):WRITEERR"
|
|
6959 : endtry
|
|
6960 :endfunction
|
|
6961 :
|
|
6962 :try
|
|
6963 :
|
|
6964 : " something with arithmetics and I/O
|
|
6965 :
|
|
6966 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE/
|
|
6967 : let function = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(\a\+\)).*', '\1', "")
|
|
6968 : echo "Range error in" function
|
|
6969 :
|
|
6970 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR/ " catches OVERFLOW and ZERODIV
|
|
6971 : echo "Math error"
|
|
6972 :
|
|
6973 :catch /^EXCEPT:IO/
|
|
6974 : let dir = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(.\+\),\s*.\+).*', '\1', "")
|
|
6975 : let file = substitute(v:exception, '.*(.\+,\s*\(.\+\)).*', '\1', "")
|
|
6976 : if file !~ '^/'
|
|
6977 : let file = dir . "/" . file
|
|
6978 : endif
|
|
6979 : echo 'I/O error for "' . file . '"'
|
|
6980 :
|
|
6981 :catch /^EXCEPT/
|
|
6982 : echo "Unspecified error"
|
|
6983 :
|
|
6984 :endtry
|
|
6985
|
|
6986 The exceptions raised by Vim itself (on error or when pressing CTRL-C) use
|
|
6987 a flat hierarchy: they are all in the "Vim" class. You cannot throw yourself
|
|
6988 exceptions with the "Vim" prefix; they are reserved for Vim.
|
|
6989 Vim error exceptions are parameterized with the name of the command that
|
|
6990 failed, if known. See |catch-errors|.
|
|
6991
|
|
6992
|
|
6993 PECULIARITIES
|
|
6994 *except-compat*
|
|
6995 The exception handling concept requires that the command sequence causing the
|
|
6996 exception is aborted immediately and control is transferred to finally clauses
|
|
6997 and/or a catch clause.
|
|
6998
|
|
6999 In the Vim script language there are cases where scripts and functions
|
|
7000 continue after an error: in functions without the "abort" flag or in a command
|
|
7001 after ":silent!", control flow goes to the following line, and outside
|
|
7002 functions, control flow goes to the line following the outermost ":endwhile"
|
|
7003 or ":endif". On the other hand, errors should be catchable as exceptions
|
|
7004 (thus, requiring the immediate abortion).
|
|
7005
|
|
7006 This problem has been solved by converting errors to exceptions and using
|
|
7007 immediate abortion (if not suppressed by ":silent!") only when a try
|
|
7008 conditional is active. This is no restriction since an (error) exception can
|
|
7009 be caught only from an active try conditional. If you want an immediate
|
|
7010 termination without catching the error, just use a try conditional without
|
|
7011 catch clause. (You can cause cleanup code being executed before termination
|
|
7012 by specifying a finally clause.)
|
|
7013
|
|
7014 When no try conditional is active, the usual abortion and continuation
|
|
7015 behavior is used instead of immediate abortion. This ensures compatibility of
|
|
7016 scripts written for Vim 6.1 and earlier.
|
|
7017
|
|
7018 However, when sourcing an existing script that does not use exception handling
|
|
7019 commands (or when calling one of its functions) from inside an active try
|
|
7020 conditional of a new script, you might change the control flow of the existing
|
|
7021 script on error. You get the immediate abortion on error and can catch the
|
|
7022 error in the new script. If however the sourced script suppresses error
|
|
7023 messages by using the ":silent!" command (checking for errors by testing
|
|
7024 |v:errmsg| if appropriate), its execution path is not changed. The error is
|
|
7025 not converted to an exception. (See |:silent|.) So the only remaining cause
|
|
7026 where this happens is for scripts that don't care about errors and produce
|
|
7027 error messages. You probably won't want to use such code from your new
|
|
7028 scripts.
|
|
7029
|
|
7030 *except-syntax-err*
|
|
7031 Syntax errors in the exception handling commands are never caught by any of
|
|
7032 the ":catch" commands of the try conditional they belong to. Its finally
|
|
7033 clauses, however, is executed.
|
|
7034 Example: >
|
|
7035
|
|
7036 :try
|
|
7037 : try
|
|
7038 : throw 4711
|
|
7039 : catch /\(/
|
|
7040 : echo "in catch with syntax error"
|
|
7041 : catch
|
|
7042 : echo "inner catch-all"
|
|
7043 : finally
|
|
7044 : echo "inner finally"
|
|
7045 : endtry
|
|
7046 :catch
|
|
7047 : echo 'outer catch-all caught "' . v:exception . '"'
|
|
7048 : finally
|
|
7049 : echo "outer finally"
|
|
7050 :endtry
|
|
7051
|
|
7052 This displays: >
|
|
7053 inner finally
|
|
7054 outer catch-all caught "Vim(catch):E54: Unmatched \("
|
|
7055 outer finally
|
|
7056 The original exception is discarded and an error exception is raised, instead.
|
|
7057
|
|
7058 *except-single-line*
|
|
7059 The ":try", ":catch", ":finally", and ":endtry" commands can be put on
|
|
7060 a single line, but then syntax errors may make it difficult to recognize the
|
|
7061 "catch" line, thus you better avoid this.
|
|
7062 Example: >
|
|
7063 :try | unlet! foo # | catch | endtry
|
|
7064 raises an error exception for the trailing characters after the ":unlet!"
|
|
7065 argument, but does not see the ":catch" and ":endtry" commands, so that the
|
|
7066 error exception is discarded and the "E488: Trailing characters" message gets
|
|
7067 displayed.
|
|
7068
|
|
7069 *except-several-errors*
|
|
7070 When several errors appear in a single command, the first error message is
|
|
7071 usually the most specific one and therefor converted to the error exception.
|
|
7072 Example: >
|
|
7073 echo novar
|
|
7074 causes >
|
|
7075 E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
7076 E15: Invalid expression: novar
|
|
7077 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
|
|
7078 Vim(echo):E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
7079 < *except-syntax-error*
|
|
7080 But when a syntax error is detected after a normal error in the same command,
|
|
7081 the syntax error is used for the exception being thrown.
|
|
7082 Example: >
|
|
7083 unlet novar #
|
|
7084 causes >
|
|
7085 E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
7086 E488: Trailing characters
|
|
7087 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
|
|
7088 Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters
|
|
7089 This is done because the syntax error might change the execution path in a way
|
|
7090 not intended by the user. Example: >
|
|
7091 try
|
|
7092 try | unlet novar # | catch | echo v:exception | endtry
|
|
7093 catch /.*/
|
|
7094 echo "outer catch:" v:exception
|
|
7095 endtry
|
|
7096 This displays "outer catch: Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters", and then
|
|
7097 a "E600: Missing :endtry" error message is given, see |except-single-line|.
|
|
7098
|
|
7099 ==============================================================================
|
|
7100 9. Examples *eval-examples*
|
|
7101
|
|
7102 Printing in Hex ~
|
|
7103 >
|
|
7104 :" The function Nr2Hex() returns the Hex string of a number.
|
|
7105 :func Nr2Hex(nr)
|
|
7106 : let n = a:nr
|
|
7107 : let r = ""
|
|
7108 : while n
|
|
7109 : let r = '0123456789ABCDEF'[n % 16] . r
|
|
7110 : let n = n / 16
|
|
7111 : endwhile
|
|
7112 : return r
|
|
7113 :endfunc
|
|
7114
|
|
7115 :" The function String2Hex() converts each character in a string to a two
|
|
7116 :" character Hex string.
|
|
7117 :func String2Hex(str)
|
|
7118 : let out = ''
|
|
7119 : let ix = 0
|
|
7120 : while ix < strlen(a:str)
|
|
7121 : let out = out . Nr2Hex(char2nr(a:str[ix]))
|
|
7122 : let ix = ix + 1
|
|
7123 : endwhile
|
|
7124 : return out
|
|
7125 :endfunc
|
|
7126
|
|
7127 Example of its use: >
|
|
7128 :echo Nr2Hex(32)
|
|
7129 result: "20" >
|
|
7130 :echo String2Hex("32")
|
|
7131 result: "3332"
|
|
7132
|
|
7133
|
|
7134 Sorting lines (by Robert Webb) ~
|
|
7135
|
|
7136 Here is a Vim script to sort lines. Highlight the lines in Vim and type
|
|
7137 ":Sort". This doesn't call any external programs so it'll work on any
|
|
7138 platform. The function Sort() actually takes the name of a comparison
|
|
7139 function as its argument, like qsort() does in C. So you could supply it
|
|
7140 with different comparison functions in order to sort according to date etc.
|
|
7141 >
|
|
7142 :" Function for use with Sort(), to compare two strings.
|
|
7143 :func! Strcmp(str1, str2)
|
|
7144 : if (a:str1 < a:str2)
|
|
7145 : return -1
|
|
7146 : elseif (a:str1 > a:str2)
|
|
7147 : return 1
|
|
7148 : else
|
|
7149 : return 0
|
|
7150 : endif
|
|
7151 :endfunction
|
|
7152
|
|
7153 :" Sort lines. SortR() is called recursively.
|
|
7154 :func! SortR(start, end, cmp)
|
|
7155 : if (a:start >= a:end)
|
|
7156 : return
|
|
7157 : endif
|
|
7158 : let partition = a:start - 1
|
|
7159 : let middle = partition
|
|
7160 : let partStr = getline((a:start + a:end) / 2)
|
|
7161 : let i = a:start
|
|
7162 : while (i <= a:end)
|
|
7163 : let str = getline(i)
|
|
7164 : exec "let result = " . a:cmp . "(str, partStr)"
|
|
7165 : if (result <= 0)
|
|
7166 : " Need to put it before the partition. Swap lines i and partition.
|
|
7167 : let partition = partition + 1
|
|
7168 : if (result == 0)
|
|
7169 : let middle = partition
|
|
7170 : endif
|
|
7171 : if (i != partition)
|
|
7172 : let str2 = getline(partition)
|
|
7173 : call setline(i, str2)
|
|
7174 : call setline(partition, str)
|
|
7175 : endif
|
|
7176 : endif
|
|
7177 : let i = i + 1
|
|
7178 : endwhile
|
|
7179
|
|
7180 : " Now we have a pointer to the "middle" element, as far as partitioning
|
|
7181 : " goes, which could be anywhere before the partition. Make sure it is at
|
|
7182 : " the end of the partition.
|
|
7183 : if (middle != partition)
|
|
7184 : let str = getline(middle)
|
|
7185 : let str2 = getline(partition)
|
|
7186 : call setline(middle, str2)
|
|
7187 : call setline(partition, str)
|
|
7188 : endif
|
|
7189 : call SortR(a:start, partition - 1, a:cmp)
|
|
7190 : call SortR(partition + 1, a:end, a:cmp)
|
|
7191 :endfunc
|
|
7192
|
|
7193 :" To Sort a range of lines, pass the range to Sort() along with the name of a
|
|
7194 :" function that will compare two lines.
|
|
7195 :func! Sort(cmp) range
|
|
7196 : call SortR(a:firstline, a:lastline, a:cmp)
|
|
7197 :endfunc
|
|
7198
|
|
7199 :" :Sort takes a range of lines and sorts them.
|
|
7200 :command! -nargs=0 -range Sort <line1>,<line2>call Sort("Strcmp")
|
|
7201 <
|
|
7202 *sscanf*
|
|
7203 There is no sscanf() function in Vim. If you need to extract parts from a
|
|
7204 line, you can use matchstr() and substitute() to do it. This example shows
|
|
7205 how to get the file name, line number and column number out of a line like
|
|
7206 "foobar.txt, 123, 45". >
|
|
7207 :" Set up the match bit
|
|
7208 :let mx='\(\f\+\),\s*\(\d\+\),\s*\(\d\+\)'
|
|
7209 :"get the part matching the whole expression
|
|
7210 :let l = matchstr(line, mx)
|
|
7211 :"get each item out of the match
|
|
7212 :let file = substitute(l, mx, '\1', '')
|
|
7213 :let lnum = substitute(l, mx, '\2', '')
|
|
7214 :let col = substitute(l, mx, '\3', '')
|
|
7215
|
|
7216 The input is in the variable "line", the results in the variables "file",
|
|
7217 "lnum" and "col". (idea from Michael Geddes)
|
|
7218
|
|
7219 ==============================================================================
|
|
7220 10. No +eval feature *no-eval-feature*
|
|
7221
|
|
7222 When the |+eval| feature was disabled at compile time, none of the expression
|
|
7223 evaluation commands are available. To prevent this from causing Vim scripts
|
|
7224 to generate all kinds of errors, the ":if" and ":endif" commands are still
|
|
7225 recognized, though the argument of the ":if" and everything between the ":if"
|
|
7226 and the matching ":endif" is ignored. Nesting of ":if" blocks is allowed, but
|
|
7227 only if the commands are at the start of the line. The ":else" command is not
|
|
7228 recognized.
|
|
7229
|
|
7230 Example of how to avoid executing commands when the |+eval| feature is
|
|
7231 missing: >
|
|
7232
|
|
7233 :if 1
|
|
7234 : echo "Expression evaluation is compiled in"
|
|
7235 :else
|
|
7236 : echo "You will _never_ see this message"
|
|
7237 :endif
|
|
7238
|
|
7239 ==============================================================================
|
|
7240 11. The sandbox *eval-sandbox* *sandbox* *E48*
|
|
7241
|
|
7242 The 'foldexpr', 'includeexpr', 'indentexpr', 'statusline' and 'foldtext'
|
|
7243 options are evaluated in a sandbox. This means that you are protected from
|
|
7244 these expressions having nasty side effects. This gives some safety for when
|
|
7245 these options are set from a modeline. It is also used when the command from
|
620
|
7246 a tags file is executed and for CTRL-R = in the command line.
|
29
|
7247 The sandbox is also used for the |:sandbox| command.
|
7
|
7248
|
|
7249 These items are not allowed in the sandbox:
|
|
7250 - changing the buffer text
|
|
7251 - defining or changing mapping, autocommands, functions, user commands
|
|
7252 - setting certain options (see |option-summary|)
|
|
7253 - executing a shell command
|
|
7254 - reading or writing a file
|
|
7255 - jumping to another buffer or editing a file
|
625
|
7256 - executing Python, Perl, etc. commands
|
29
|
7257 This is not guaranteed 100% secure, but it should block most attacks.
|
|
7258
|
|
7259 *:san* *:sandbox*
|
401
|
7260 :san[dbox] {cmd} Execute {cmd} in the sandbox. Useful to evaluate an
|
29
|
7261 option that may have been set from a modeline, e.g.
|
|
7262 'foldexpr'.
|
|
7263
|
634
|
7264 *sandbox-option*
|
|
7265 A few options contain an expression. When this expression is evaluated it may
|
790
|
7266 have to be done in the sandbox to avoid a security risk. But the sandbox is
|
634
|
7267 restrictive, thus this only happens when the option was set from an insecure
|
|
7268 location. Insecure in this context are:
|
|
7269 - sourcing a .vimrc or .exrc in the current directlry
|
|
7270 - while executing in the sandbox
|
|
7271 - value coming from a modeline
|
|
7272
|
|
7273 Note that when in the sandbox and saving an option value and restoring it, the
|
|
7274 option will still be marked as it was set in the sandbox.
|
|
7275
|
|
7276 ==============================================================================
|
|
7277 12. Textlock *textlock*
|
|
7278
|
|
7279 In a few situations it is not allowed to change the text in the buffer, jump
|
|
7280 to another window and some other things that might confuse or break what Vim
|
|
7281 is currently doing. This mostly applies to things that happen when Vim is
|
|
7282 actually doing something else. For example, evaluating the 'balloonexpr' may
|
|
7283 happen any moment the mouse cursor is resting at some position.
|
|
7284
|
|
7285 This is not allowed when the textlock is active:
|
|
7286 - changing the buffer text
|
|
7287 - jumping to another buffer or window
|
|
7288 - editing another file
|
|
7289 - closing a window or quitting Vim
|
|
7290 - etc.
|
|
7291
|
7
|
7292
|
|
7293 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
|